blob: 76b093e70d61419c7a2dbe67b0fac55acaa509d4 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau1a34d572014-02-03 00:41:29 +01007 2014/02/03
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
727.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
737.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
757.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
767.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078
798. Logging
808.1. Log levels
818.2. Log formats
828.2.1. Default log format
838.2.2. TCP log format
848.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100858.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100868.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200878.3. Advanced logging options
888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
928.4. Timing events
938.5. Session state at disconnection
948.6. Non-printable characters
958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
978.9. Examples of logs
98
999. Statistics and monitoring
1009.1. CSV format
1019.2. Unix Socket commands
102
103
1041. Quick reminder about HTTP
105----------------------------
106
107When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
108fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
109on almost anything found in the contents.
110
111However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
112formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
113correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
114
115
1161.1. The HTTP transaction model
117-------------------------------
118
119The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100120to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
122connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
123will involve a new connection :
124
125 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
126
127In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
128establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
129by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
130length.
131
132Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
133to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
134however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
135response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
136header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
137
138 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
139
140Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
141power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
142but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200143a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144
145A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
146keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
147second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
148page :
149
150 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
151
152This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
153latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
154correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
155the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100156server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100158By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
159connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
160leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
161start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200162
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100163HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
164 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
165 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
166 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
167 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
168 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
169 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
1721.2. HTTP request
173-----------------
174
175First, let's consider this HTTP request :
176
177 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100178 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
180 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
181 3 User-agent: my small browser
182 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
183 5 Accept: image/png
184
185
1861.2.1. The Request line
187-----------------------
188
189Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
190
191 - a METHOD : GET
192 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
193 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
194
195All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
196which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
197followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
198is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
199desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
200the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
201
202The URI itself can have several forms :
203
204 - A "relative URI" :
205
206 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
207
208 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
209 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
210
211 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
212
213 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
214
215 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
216 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
217 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
218 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
219 must accept this form too.
220
221 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
222 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
223 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100224
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
226 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
227 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
228 other protocols too.
229
230In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
231mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
232on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
233It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
234specific to the language, framework or application in use.
235
236
2371.2.2. The request headers
238--------------------------
239
240The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
241beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
242an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
243Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
244values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
245encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
246the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
247define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
248
249Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
250their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
251"Connection:" header).
252
253The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
254that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
255is one valid form of empty line.
256
257Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
258headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
259about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
260application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
261
262Important note:
263 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
264 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
265 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
266 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
267
268
2691.3. HTTP response
270------------------
271
272An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
273messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
274
275 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100276 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200277 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
278 2 Content-length: 350
279 3 Content-Type: text/html
280
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200281As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
282codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
283response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100284continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
285the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
286following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
287sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
288(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
289correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
290such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
291state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
292over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
293if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
294information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296
2971.3.1. The Response line
298------------------------
299
300Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
301
302 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
303 - a status code : 200
304 - a reason : OK
305
306The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200307 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
309 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
310 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
311 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
312
313Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100314"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200315found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
316messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
317or "Authentication Required".
318
319Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
320
321 Code When / reason
322 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
323 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
324 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100326 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
327 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200328 400 for an invalid or too large request
329 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
330 accessing the stats page)
331 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
332 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
333 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
334 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
335 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
336 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
337 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
338 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
339 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
340
341The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3424.2).
343
344
3451.3.2. The response headers
346---------------------------
347
348Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
349the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
350details.
351
352
3532. Configuring HAProxy
354----------------------
355
3562.1. Configuration file format
357------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200358
359HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
360
361 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
362 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
363 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
364 "frontend" and "backend".
365
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100366The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
367referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
368delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100369preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100370escaped by doubling them.
371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372
3732.2. Time format
374----------------
375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100376Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
378otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
379numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
380for every keyword. Supported units are :
381
382 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
383 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
384 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
385 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
386 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
387 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
388
389
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003902.3. Examples
391-------------
392
393 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
394 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
395 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
396 global
397 daemon
398 maxconn 256
399
400 defaults
401 mode http
402 timeout connect 5000ms
403 timeout client 50000ms
404 timeout server 50000ms
405
406 frontend http-in
407 bind *:80
408 default_backend servers
409
410 backend servers
411 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
412
413
414 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
415 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
416 global
417 daemon
418 maxconn 256
419
420 defaults
421 mode http
422 timeout connect 5000ms
423 timeout client 50000ms
424 timeout server 50000ms
425
426 listen http-in
427 bind *:80
428 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
429
430
431Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
432
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100433 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200434
435
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004363. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200437--------------------
438
439Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
440are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
441of them have command-line equivalents.
442
443The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
444
445 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200446 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200448 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200449 - daemon
450 - gid
451 - group
452 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100453 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200454 - nbproc
455 - pidfile
456 - uid
457 - ulimit-n
458 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200459 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100460 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200461 - node
462 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100463 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100464
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200465 * Performance tuning
466 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200467 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100468 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100469 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100470 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200471 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200472 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200473 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200474 - noepoll
475 - nokqueue
476 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100477 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300478 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200479 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200480 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200481 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100482 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100483 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200484 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100485 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100486 - tune.maxaccept
487 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200488 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200489 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100490 - tune.rcvbuf.client
491 - tune.rcvbuf.server
492 - tune.sndbuf.client
493 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100494 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100495 - tune.ssl.lifetime
496 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100497 - tune.zlib.memlevel
498 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100499
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200500 * Debugging
501 - debug
502 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200503
504
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005053.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506------------------------------------
507
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200508ca-base <dir>
509 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200510 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
511 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200512
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200513chroot <jail dir>
514 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
515 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
516 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
517 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
518 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
519 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100520
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100521cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
522 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
523 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
524 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
525 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
526 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
527 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
528 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
529 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
530 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
531 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
532 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
533 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
534 they overlap.
535
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200536crt-base <dir>
537 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
538 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
539 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200541daemon
542 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
543 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
544 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
545
546gid <number>
547 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
548 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
549 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100550 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
551 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100553
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200554group <group name>
555 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
556 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100557
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200558log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200559 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
560 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100561 configured with "log global".
562
563 <address> can be one of:
564
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100565 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100566 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
567 port).
568
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100569 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
570 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
571 port).
572
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100573 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
574 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
575 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
576 writeable).
577
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100578 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
579 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
580 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
581 in Bourne shell.
582
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100583 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584
585 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
586 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
587 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
588
589 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200590 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
591 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
592 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
593 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
594 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
595 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200596
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200597 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100599log-send-hostname [<string>]
600 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
601 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
602 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
603 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
604 the logs.
605
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000606log-tag <string>
607 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
608 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
609 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
610 running on the same host.
611
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612nbproc <number>
613 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
614 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
615 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
616 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
617 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
618
619pidfile <pidfile>
620 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
621 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
622 starting the process. See also "daemon".
623
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100624stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200625 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
626 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
627 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
628 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
629 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
630 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
631 the number of processes used.
632
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100633ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
634 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
635 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300636 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100637 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
638 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
639 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
640 "bind" keyword for more information.
641
642ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
643 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
644 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300645 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100646 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
647 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
648 information.
649
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100650ssl-server-verify [none|required]
651 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
652 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
653 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
654
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200655stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
656 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
657 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
658 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
659 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200660
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200661 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
662 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
663 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200664
665stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
666 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
667 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100668 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200669
670stats maxconn <connections>
671 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
672 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
673
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674uid <number>
675 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
676 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
677 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
678 one. See also "gid" and "user".
679
680ulimit-n <number>
681 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
682 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
683 option.
684
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100685unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
686 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
687
688 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
689 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
690 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
691 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
692 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
693 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
694 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
695 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
696 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
697 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
698
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200699user <user name>
700 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
701 See also "uid" and "group".
702
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200703node <name>
704 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
705
706 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
707 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
708 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
709 traffic.
710
711description <text>
712 Add a text that describes the instance.
713
714 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
715 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
716 "<" and ">" characters.
717
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007193.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720-----------------------
721
722maxconn <number>
723 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
724 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
725 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
726 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
727
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200728maxconnrate <number>
729 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
730 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
731 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
732 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
733 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
734 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
735 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
736 fairness.
737
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100738maxcomprate <number>
739 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300740 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100741 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
742 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
743 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
744 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
745 default value.
746
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100747maxcompcpuusage <number>
748 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
749 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
750 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
751 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
752 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
753 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
754 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
755 process down and from introducing high latencies.
756
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100757maxpipes <number>
758 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
759 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
760 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
761 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
762 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
763 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
764
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200765maxsessrate <number>
766 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
767 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
768 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
769 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
770 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
771 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
772 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
773 fairness.
774
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200775maxsslconn <number>
776 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
777 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
778 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
779 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
780 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
781 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
782 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
783
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200784maxsslrate <number>
785 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
786 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
787 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
788 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
789 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
790 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
791 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
792 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
793 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
794 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
795
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100796maxzlibmem <number>
797 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
798 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
799 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100800 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
801 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
802 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
803
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804noepoll
805 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
806 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100807 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200808
809nokqueue
810 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
811 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
812 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
813
814nopoll
815 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
816 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100817 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100818 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100820nosplice
821 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
822 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
823 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100824 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100825 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
826 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
827 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
828 "option splice-response".
829
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300830nogetaddrinfo
831 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
832 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
833
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200834spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900835 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
836 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
837 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
838 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
839 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
840 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200841
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200842tune.bufsize <number>
843 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
844 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
845 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
846 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
847 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
848 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
849 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
850 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400851 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
852 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
853 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200854
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200855tune.chksize <number>
856 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
857 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
858 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
859 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
860 checks whenever possible.
861
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100862tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
863 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
864 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
865 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
866 this value. The default value is 1.
867
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100868tune.http.cookielen <number>
869 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
870 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
871 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
872 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
873 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
874 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
875 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
876 to change this value.
877
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200878tune.http.maxhdr <number>
879 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
880 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
881 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
882 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
883 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
884 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
885 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
886 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
887 limit too high.
888
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100889tune.idletimer <timeout>
890 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
891 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
892 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
893 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
894 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
895 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
896 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
897 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
898 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
899
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100900tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100901 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
902 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
903 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
904 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
905 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
906 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
907 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
908 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
909 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
910 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100911
912tune.maxpollevents <number>
913 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
914 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
915 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
916 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
917 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
918
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200919tune.maxrewrite <number>
920 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
921 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
922 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
923 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
924 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
925 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
926 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
927 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
928 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
929 bufsize.
930
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200931tune.pipesize <number>
932 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
933 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
934 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
935 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
936 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
937 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
938
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100939tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
940tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
941 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
942 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
943 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
944 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
945 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
946 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
947 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
948
949tune.sndbuf.client <number>
950tune.sndbuf.server <number>
951 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
952 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
953 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
954 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
955 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
956 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
957 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
958 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
959 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
960 notifying haproxy again.
961
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100962tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100963 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
964 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
965 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300966 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100967 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
968 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
969 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
970 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
971 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100972 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
973 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100974
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100975tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
976 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300977 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100978 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
979 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
980 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
981 being used for too long.
982
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100983tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
984 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
985 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
986 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
987 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
988 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
989 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
990 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
991 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
992 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
993 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100994 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
995 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100996
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100997tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
998 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300999 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001000 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1001 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1002 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1003
1004tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1005 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1006 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1007 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1008 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001009
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010103.3. Debugging
1011--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001012
1013debug
1014 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1015 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1016 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1017 system startup.
1018
1019quiet
1020 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1021 line argument "-q".
1022
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001023
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010243.4. Userlists
1025--------------
1026It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1027http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1028it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1029
1030userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001031 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001032 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1033
1034group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001035 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001036 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1037 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1038
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001039user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1040 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001041 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1042 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001043 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1044 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001045 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001046 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001047
1048
1049 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001050 userlist L1
1051 group G1 users tiger,scott
1052 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001053
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001054 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1055 user scott insecure-password elgato
1056 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001057
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001058 userlist L2
1059 group G1
1060 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001061
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001062 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1063 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1064 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001065
1066 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001067
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001068
10693.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001070----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001071It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1072haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1073pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1074identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1075or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1076Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1077known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1078the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1079process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1080during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1081tables.
1082
1083peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001084 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001085 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1086
1087peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1088 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1089 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1090 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1091 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1092 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1093 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1094
1095 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1096 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1097
1098 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1099 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1100 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1101 across all peers.
1102
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001103 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1104 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1105 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1106
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001107 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001108 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001109 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1110 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1111 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001112
1113 backend mybackend
1114 mode tcp
1115 balance roundrobin
1116 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1117 stick on src
1118
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001119 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1120 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001121
1122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011234. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001125
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001126Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1127 - defaults <name>
1128 - frontend <name>
1129 - backend <name>
1130 - listen <name>
1131
1132A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1133its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1134section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001135section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136
1137A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1138connections.
1139
1140A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1141to forward incoming connections.
1142
1143A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1144parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1145
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001146All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1147'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1148case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1149
1150Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1151logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1152proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1153However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1154name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1155
1156Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1157and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001158bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001159protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1160modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1161arbitrary criteria.
1162
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001163In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1164a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1165the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1166
1167 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1168 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1169 between responses and new requests.
1170
1171 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1172 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1173 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1174 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1175
1176 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1177 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1178 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1179
1180 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1181 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1182 client-facing connection remains open.
1183
1184 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1185 after the end of the response.
1186
1187The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1188frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1189following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1190weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1191
1192 Backend mode
1193
1194 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1195 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1196 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1197 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1198 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1199 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1200 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1201 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1202 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1203 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1204 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1205
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001206
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012084.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1209--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001211The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1212limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1213they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1214limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001215marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001216option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001217and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1218with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1219specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001220
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001221
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001222 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1223------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1224acl - X X X
1225appsession - - X X
1226backlog X X X -
1227balance X - X X
1228bind - X X -
1229bind-process X X X X
1230block - X X X
1231capture cookie - X X -
1232capture request header - X X -
1233capture response header - X X -
1234clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001235compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001236contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1237cookie X - X X
1238default-server X - X X
1239default_backend X X X -
1240description - X X X
1241disabled X X X X
1242dispatch - - X X
1243enabled X X X X
1244errorfile X X X X
1245errorloc X X X X
1246errorloc302 X X X X
1247-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1248errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001249force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001250fullconn X - X X
1251grace X X X X
1252hash-type X - X X
1253http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001254http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001255http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001256http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001257http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01001258tcp-check connect - - X X
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02001259tcp-check expect - - X X
1260tcp-check send - - X X
1261tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001262http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001263id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001264ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001265log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001266maxconn X X X -
1267mode X X X X
1268monitor fail - X X -
1269monitor-net X X X -
1270monitor-uri X X X -
1271option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1272option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1273option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1274option allbackups (*) X - X X
1275option checkcache (*) X - X X
1276option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1277option contstats (*) X X X -
1278option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1279option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1280option forceclose (*) X X X X
1281-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1282option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001283option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001284option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001285option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001286option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001287option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001288option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1289option httpchk X - X X
1290option httpclose (*) X X X X
1291option httplog X X X X
1292option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001293option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001294option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001295option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1296option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1297option logasap (*) X X X -
1298option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001299option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001300option nolinger (*) X X X X
1301option originalto X X X X
1302option persist (*) X - X X
1303option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001304option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001305option smtpchk X - X X
1306option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1307option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1308option splice-request (*) X X X X
1309option splice-response (*) X X X X
1310option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1311option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1312-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001313option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001314option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1315option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1316option tcpka X X X X
1317option tcplog X X X X
1318option transparent (*) X - X X
1319persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1320rate-limit sessions X X X -
1321redirect - X X X
1322redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1323redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1324reqadd - X X X
1325reqallow - X X X
1326reqdel - X X X
1327reqdeny - X X X
1328reqiallow - X X X
1329reqidel - X X X
1330reqideny - X X X
1331reqipass - X X X
1332reqirep - X X X
1333reqisetbe - X X X
1334reqitarpit - X X X
1335reqpass - X X X
1336reqrep - X X X
1337-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1338reqsetbe - X X X
1339reqtarpit - X X X
1340retries X - X X
1341rspadd - X X X
1342rspdel - X X X
1343rspdeny - X X X
1344rspidel - X X X
1345rspideny - X X X
1346rspirep - X X X
1347rsprep - X X X
1348server - - X X
1349source X - X X
1350srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001351stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001352stats auth X - X X
1353stats enable X - X X
1354stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001355stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001356stats realm X - X X
1357stats refresh X - X X
1358stats scope X - X X
1359stats show-desc X - X X
1360stats show-legends X - X X
1361stats show-node X - X X
1362stats uri X - X X
1363-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1364stick match - - X X
1365stick on - - X X
1366stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001367stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001368stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001369tcp-request connection - X X -
1370tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001371tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001372tcp-response content - - X X
1373tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001374timeout check X - X X
1375timeout client X X X -
1376timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1377timeout connect X - X X
1378timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1379timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1380timeout http-request X X X X
1381timeout queue X - X X
1382timeout server X - X X
1383timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1384timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001385timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001386transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001387unique-id-format X X X -
1388unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001389use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001390use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001391------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1392 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001393
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001394
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013954.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1396---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001397
1398This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1399
1400
1401acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1402 Declare or complete an access list.
1403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1404 no | yes | yes | yes
1405 Example:
1406 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1407 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1408 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1409
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001410 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001411
1412
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001413appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1414 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001415 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1417 no | no | yes | yes
1418 Arguments :
1419 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1420 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1421
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001422 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001423 checked in each cookie value.
1424
1425 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1426 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1427 milliseconds.
1428
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001429 request-learn
1430 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1431 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1432 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1433 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1434 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1435 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1436
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001437 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1438 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1439 data following this prefix.
1440
1441 Example :
1442 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1443
1444 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1445 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1446
1447 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1448 2 modes are currently supported :
1449 - path-parameters :
1450 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1451 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1452 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1453 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1454 - query-string :
1455 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1456 query string.
1457
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001458 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1459 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1460 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1461 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001462 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1463 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1464 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001465 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1466 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1467
1468 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1469
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001470 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1471 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1472 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1473
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001474 Example :
1475 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1476
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001477 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1478 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001479
1480
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001481backlog <conns>
1482 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1484 yes | yes | yes | no
1485 Arguments :
1486 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1487 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001488 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001489
1490 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1491 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1492 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1493 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1494 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1495 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1496 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1497 backlog parameter.
1498
1499 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1500 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1501 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1502
1503 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1504
1505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001506balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001507balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001508 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1510 yes | no | yes | yes
1511 Arguments :
1512 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1513 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1514 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1515 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1516
1517 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1518 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1519 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1520 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001521 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001522 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001523 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1524 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1525 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1526 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1527 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1528 it, so that you don't worry.
1529
1530 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1531 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1532 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1533 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1534 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1535 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1536 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1537 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001538
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001539 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1540 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1541 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1542 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1543 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1544 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1545 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1546 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1547
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001548 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001549 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001550 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1551 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001552 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001553 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1554 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1555 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1556 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1557 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001558 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1559 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1560 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1561 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1562 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1563 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001564
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001565 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1566 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1567 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1568 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1569 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1570 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1571 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1572 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001573 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001574 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001575 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1576 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1577 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001578
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001579 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1580 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1581 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1582 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1583 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1584 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1585 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1586 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1587 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1588 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1589 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1590 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001591
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001592 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001593 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1594 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1595 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1596 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1597 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1598 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1599 URIs start with a leading "/".
1600
1601 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1602 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1603 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1604 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001607 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1608
1609 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001610 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1611 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001612 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1613 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1614 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1615 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001616 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001617 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1618 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001619
1620 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1621 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1622 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1623 server will receive the request.
1624
1625 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1626 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1627 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1628 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1629 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001630 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1631 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1632 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001633
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001634 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1635 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1636 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1637 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1638 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001639
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001640 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001641 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1642 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1643 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1644
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001645 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1646 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1647 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1648
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001649 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001650 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001651 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1652 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1653 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1654 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1655 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1656 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001657 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001658 used instead.
1659
1660 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1661 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1662 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1663 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1664
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001665 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1666 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1667 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1668
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001669 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001670
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001671 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001672 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1673 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001674
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001675 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1676 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1677 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001678
1679 Examples :
1680 balance roundrobin
1681 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001682 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001683 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1684 balance hdr(host)
1685 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001686
1687 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1688 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1689
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001690 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001691 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1692 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1693 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1694 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1695
1696 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1697 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1698 defaults to 16 kB.
1699
1700 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1701 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1702
1703 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1704 Round Robin.
1705
1706 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1707 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1708 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1709 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1710
1711 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1712
1713 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001714 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001715 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1716 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1717 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001718
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001719 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1720 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001721
1722
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001723bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1724bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001725 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1727 no | yes | yes | no
1728 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001729 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1730 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1731 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1732 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001733 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001734 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1735 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1736 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1737 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1738 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1739 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1740 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001741 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1742 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1743 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001744 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1745 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1746 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1747 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001748
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001749 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1750 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001751 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1752 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1753 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001754 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1755 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1756 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1757 the range.
1758
1759 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1760 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1761 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1762 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1763 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1764 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1765 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001766 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001767 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001768
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001769 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1770 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1771 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1772 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1773 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1774 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1775 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1776 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1777
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001778 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1779 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1780 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1781 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001782
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001783 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1784 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1785 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1786 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1787 in a frontend.
1788
1789 Example :
1790 listen http_proxy
1791 bind :80,:443
1792 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001793 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001794
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001795 listen http_https_proxy
1796 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001797 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001798
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001799 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1800 bind ipv6@:80
1801 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1802 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1803
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001804 listen external_bind_app1
1805 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1806
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001807 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001808 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001809
1810
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001811bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001812 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1814 yes | yes | yes | yes
1815 Arguments :
1816 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1817 may be used to override a default value.
1818
1819 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1820 option may be combined with other numbers.
1821
1822 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1823 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1824 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1825 missing from all processes.
1826
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001827 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1828 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1829 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1830 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1831 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001832
1833 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1834 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1835 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1836 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1837 and 'even' instances.
1838
1839 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1840 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1841 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1842 32.
1843
1844 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1845 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1846
1847 Example :
1848 listen app_ip1
1849 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001850 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001851
1852 listen app_ip2
1853 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001854 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001855
1856 listen management
1857 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001858 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001859
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001860 listen management
1861 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1862 bind-process 1-4
1863
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001864 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1865
1866
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001867block { if | unless } <condition>
1868 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1870 no | yes | yes | yes
1871
1872 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1873 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001874 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001875 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001876 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1877 "block" statements per instance.
1878
1879 Example:
1880 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1881 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1882 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1883 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001885 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001886
1887
1888capture cookie <name> len <length>
1889 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1891 no | yes | yes | no
1892 Arguments :
1893 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1894 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1895 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1896 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1897 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1898
1899 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1900 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1901 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1902 right if it exceeds <length>.
1903
1904 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1905 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1906 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1907 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1908
1909 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1910 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1911 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1912
1913 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1914 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1915 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001916 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1917 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1918 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001919
1920 Example:
1921 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1922
1923 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001924 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001925
1926
1927capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001928 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1930 no | yes | yes | no
1931 Arguments :
1932 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001933 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001934 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1935 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1936 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1937
1938 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1939 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1940 it exceeds <length>.
1941
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001942 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001943 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1944 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001945 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1946 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1947 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1948 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001949 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001950 environments to find where the request came from.
1951
1952 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1953 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1954 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1955 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001957 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1958 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1959 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1960 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1961 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001962
1963 Example:
1964 capture request header Host len 15
1965 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1966 capture request header Referrer len 15
1967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001968 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001969 about logging.
1970
1971
1972capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001973 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1975 no | yes | yes | no
1976 Arguments :
1977 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001978 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001979 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1980 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1981 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1982
1983 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1984 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1985 it exceeds <length>.
1986
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001987 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001988 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1989 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1990 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001991 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1992 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1993 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1994 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001995
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001996 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1997 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1998 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1999 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2000 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002001
2002 Example:
2003 capture response header Content-length len 9
2004 capture response header Location len 15
2005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002006 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002007 about logging.
2008
2009
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002010clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002011 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2013 yes | yes | yes | no
2014 Arguments :
2015 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2016 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2017 as explained at the top of this document.
2018
2019 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2020 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2021 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2022 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2023 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2024 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2025 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2026 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002027 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002028 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2029 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2030
2031 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2032 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2033 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2034 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2035 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2036 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2037
2038 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2039 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2040
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002041 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2042 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002043
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002044compression algo <algorithm> ...
2045compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002046compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002047 Enable HTTP compression.
2048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2049 yes | yes | yes | yes
2050 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002051 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2052 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2053 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2054
2055 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002056 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002057 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2058 data.
2059
2060 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2061 support for zlib was built in.
2062
2063 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2064 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2065 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2066 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2067 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2068 in.
2069
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002070 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002071 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002072 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2073 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2074 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2075 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2076 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002077
2078 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2079 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2080 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2081 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2082 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002083 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2084 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2085 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2086 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2087 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2088 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002089
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002090 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002091 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2092 "Accept-Encoding" header
2093 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002094 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002095 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2096 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002097 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2098 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2099 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2100 "multipart"
2101 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2102 header
2103 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2104 and later
2105 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2106 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002107
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002108 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2109 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002110
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002111 Examples :
2112 compression algo gzip
2113 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002114
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002115contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002116 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2118 yes | no | yes | yes
2119 Arguments :
2120 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2121 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2122 as explained at the top of this document.
2123
2124 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002125 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002126 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002127 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2128 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2129 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2130 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2131
2132 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2133 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2134 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2135 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2136 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2137 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2138
2139 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2140 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2141 instead.
2142
2143 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2144 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2145
2146
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002147cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002148 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2149 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002150 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2152 yes | no | yes | yes
2153 Arguments :
2154 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2155 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2156 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2157 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2158 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2159 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2160 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2161 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2162 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2163
2164 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2165 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2166 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2167 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2168 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2169 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2170 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2171 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2172 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2173 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2174 "insert" and "prefix".
2175
2176 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002177 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002178
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002179 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002180 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2181 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2182 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2183 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2184 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2185 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2186 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2187 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2188 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2189 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002190
2191 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2192 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2193 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2194 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2195 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2196 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2197 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2198 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2199 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2200 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002201 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2202 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2203 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002204
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002205 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2206 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2207 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002208 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2209 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2210 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2211 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002212 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2213 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2214 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002215
2216 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2217 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2218 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2219 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2220 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2221 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2222 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2223 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2224 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2225
2226 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2227 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2228 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2229 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2230 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2231 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2232 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2233 persistence cookie in the cache.
2234 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2235
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002236 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2237 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2238 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2239 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2240 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2241 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2242 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2243 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2244 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2245 they logout.
2246
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002247 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2248 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2249 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2250 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2251
2252 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2253 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2254 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2255 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2256 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2257 this attribute.
2258
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002259 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002260 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002261 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2262 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2263 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2264 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2265 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2266 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002267
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002268 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2269 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2270 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2271 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2272 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2273 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2274 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2275 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2276 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2277 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2278 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2279 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2280 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2281 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2282 the site.
2283
2284 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2285 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2286 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2287 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2288 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2289 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2290 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2291 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2292 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2293 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2294 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2295 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2296 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2297 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2298 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2299 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2300
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002301 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2302 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2303 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2304 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002305
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002306 Examples :
2307 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2308 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2309 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002310 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002311
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002312 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002313 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002314
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002315
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002316default-server [param*]
2317 Change default options for a server in a backend
2318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2319 yes | no | yes | yes
2320 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002321 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2322 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2323 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2324 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002325
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002326 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002327 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2328
2329 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002330
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002331
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002332default_backend <backend>
2333 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2335 yes | yes | yes | no
2336 Arguments :
2337 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2338
2339 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2340 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2341 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2342 will catch all undetermined requests.
2343
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002344 Example :
2345
2346 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2347 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2348 default_backend dynamic
2349
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002350 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2351
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002352
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002353description <string>
2354 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2356 no | yes | yes | yes
2357 Arguments : string
2358
2359 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2360 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2361 it describes.
2362 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2363
2364
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002365disabled
2366 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2368 yes | yes | yes | yes
2369 Arguments : none
2370
2371 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2372 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2373 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2374 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2375 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2376 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2377 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2378
2379 See also : "enabled"
2380
2381
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002382dispatch <address>:<port>
2383 Set a default server address
2384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2385 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002386 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002387
2388 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2389 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2390 during start-up.
2391
2392 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2393 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2394 possible with normal servers.
2395
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002396 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002397 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2398 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2399 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2400 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2401
2402 See also : "server"
2403
2404
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002405enabled
2406 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2408 yes | yes | yes | yes
2409 Arguments : none
2410
2411 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2412 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2413
2414 See also : "disabled"
2415
2416
2417errorfile <code> <file>
2418 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2420 yes | yes | yes | yes
2421 Arguments :
2422 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002423 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002424
2425 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002426 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002427 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002428 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2429 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002430
2431 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2432 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2433 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2434
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002435 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2436
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002437 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2438 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2439 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2440 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2441
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002442 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2443 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2444 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2445 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2446 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2447 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2448
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002449 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2450 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2451 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002452 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002453 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2454
2455 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2456
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002457 Example :
2458 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2459 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2460 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2461
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002462
2463errorloc <code> <url>
2464errorloc302 <code> <url>
2465 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2467 yes | yes | yes | yes
2468 Arguments :
2469 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002470 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002471
2472 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2473 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2474 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2475 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2476 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2477
2478 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2479 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2480 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2481
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002482 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2483
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002484 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2485 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2486 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2487 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2488 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2489 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2490 request.
2491
2492 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2493
2494
2495errorloc303 <code> <url>
2496 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2498 yes | yes | yes | yes
2499 Arguments :
2500 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2501 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2502
2503 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2504 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2505 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2506 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2507 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2508
2509 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2510 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2511 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2512
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002513 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2514
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002515 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2516 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2517 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2518 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002519 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002520
2521 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2522
2523
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002524force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2525 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2526 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2527 no | yes | yes | yes
2528
2529 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2530 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2531 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2532 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2533 marked down for maintenance operations.
2534
2535 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2536 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2537 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2538 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2539 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2540 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2541 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2542 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2543 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2544
2545 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2546 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2547 is used.
2548
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002549 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002550 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002551
2552
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002553fullconn <conns>
2554 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2556 yes | no | yes | yes
2557 Arguments :
2558 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2559 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2560
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002561 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002562 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002563 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002564 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2565 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2566 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2567 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2568 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002569 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002570
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002571 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2572 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002573 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2574 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2575 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002576
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002577 Example :
2578 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2579 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2580 # connections.
2581 backend dynamic
2582 fullconn 10000
2583 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2584 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2585
2586 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2587
2588
2589grace <time>
2590 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002592 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002593 Arguments :
2594 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2595 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2596 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2597
2598 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2599 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002600 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002601 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2602
2603 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2604 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2605 simplify it.
2606
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002608hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002609 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2611 yes | no | yes | yes
2612 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002613 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2614 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002615
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002616 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2617 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2618 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2619 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2620 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2621 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2622 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2623 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2624 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2625 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002626
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002627 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2628 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2629 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2630 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2631 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2632 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2633 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2634 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2635 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2636 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2637 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2638 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2639 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002640 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2641 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002642
2643 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2644
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002645 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002646 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2647 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2648 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002649 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2650 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2651 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002652
2653 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2654 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002655 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2656 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2657 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2658 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2659
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002660 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2661 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2662 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2663 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2664 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2665 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2666 parameter.
2667
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002668 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2669
2670 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2671 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2672 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2673 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2674 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2675 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2676 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2677 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2678 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2679 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2680 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2681 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002682
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002683 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2684 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2685 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002686
2687 See also : "balance", "server"
2688
2689
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002690http-check disable-on-404
2691 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002693 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002694 Arguments : none
2695
2696 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2697 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2698 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2699 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2700 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2701 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2702 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2703 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002704 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2705 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2706 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2707
2708 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2709
2710
2711http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002712 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002714 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002715 Arguments :
2716 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2717 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002718 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002719 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2720 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2721 details on the supported keywords.
2722
2723 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2724 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2725 with the usual backslash ('\').
2726
2727 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2728 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2729 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2730 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2731 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2732
2733 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002734 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002735 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2736 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2737 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2738
2739 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002740 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002741 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2742 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2743 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2744 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2745
2746 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002747 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002748 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2749 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2750 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2751 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2752 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2753 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2754 trace).
2755
2756 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002757 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002758 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2759 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2760 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2761 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2762 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2763 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2764
2765 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2766 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2767 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2768 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2769 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2770 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2771 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2772 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2773
2774 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2775 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2776
2777 Examples :
2778 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002779 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002780
2781 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002782 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002783
2784 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002785 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002786
2787 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002788 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002789
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002790 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002791
2792
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002793http-check send-state
2794 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2796 yes | no | yes | yes
2797 Arguments : none
2798
2799 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2800 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2801 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2802 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2803 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2804
2805 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2806 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2807 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2808 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2809 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2810 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2811 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2812 checked in multiple backends.
2813
2814 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2815 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2816
2817 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2818 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2819 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2820 one fails.
2821
2822 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2823 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2824 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2825
2826 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2827 server's queue.
2828
2829 Example of a header received by the application server :
2830 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2831 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2832
2833 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2834
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002835http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002836 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002837 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
2838 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002839 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002840 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2841
2842 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2843 no | yes | yes | yes
2844
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002845 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2846 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2847 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2848 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2849 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002850
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002851 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2852 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2853 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2854
2855 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2856 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2857 are evaluated.
2858
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002859 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2860 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2861 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2862 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2863 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2864 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2865 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2866 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2867 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002868 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002869 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2870
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002871 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2872 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2873 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2874 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2875 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2876
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002877 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2878 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2879 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002880 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2881 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002882
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002883 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2884 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2885 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2886 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2887 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2888 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2889 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2890 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2891
2892 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2893 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2894 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2895 external users.
2896
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002897 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2898 <name>.
2899
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002900 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2901 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2902 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2903 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2904 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2905 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2906 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2907 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2908
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002909 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2910 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2911 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2912 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2913 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2914 another equipment.
2915
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002916 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2917 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2918 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2919 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2920 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2921 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2922 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2923 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2924
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002925 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2926 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2927 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2928 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2929 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2930 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2931 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2932 admin privileges.
2933
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002934 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2935
2936 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2937 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2938 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2939 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002940
2941 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002942 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2943 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2944 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002945
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002946 http-request allow if nagios
2947 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2948 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2949 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002950
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002951 Example:
2952 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002953 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002954
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002955 Example:
2956 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2957 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2958 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2959 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2960 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2961 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2962 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2963 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2964 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2965
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002966 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2967 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002968
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002969http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002970 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
2971 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002972 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002973 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2974
2975 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2976 no | yes | yes | yes
2977
2978 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2979 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2980 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2981 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2982 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2983 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2984
2985 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2986 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2987 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
2988 current section.
2989
2990 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2991 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
2992 rules are evaluated.
2993
2994 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2995 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2996 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
2997 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
2998 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
2999 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3000 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3001
3002 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3003 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3004 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3005 external users.
3006
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003007 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3008 <name>.
3009
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003010 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3011 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3012 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3013 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3014 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3015 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3016 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3017 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3018
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003019 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3020 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3021 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3022 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3023 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3024 another equipment.
3025
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003026 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3027 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3028 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3029 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3030 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3031 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3032 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3033 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3034
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003035 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3036 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3037 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3038 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3039 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3040 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3041 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3042 admin privileges.
3043
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003044 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3045
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003046 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003047 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3048 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3049 rules.
3050
3051 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3052 ACL usage.
3053
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003054
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003055tcp-check connect [params*]
3056 Opens a new connection
3057 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3058 no | no | yes | yes
3059
3060 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
3061 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
3062 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
3063
3064 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
3065 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
3066 of the sequence.
3067
3068 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
3069 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
3070 do.
3071
3072 Parameters :
3073 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
3074 use the TCP connection.
3075
3076 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
3077 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
3078 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
3079
3080 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
3081
3082 ssl opens a ciphered connection
3083
3084 Examples:
3085 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
3086 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
3087 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
3088 option tcp-check
3089 tcp-check connect
3090 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
3091 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
3092 tcp-check send \r\n
3093 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
3094 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
3095 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
3096 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
3097 tcp-check send \r\n
3098 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
3099 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
3100
3101 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
3102 option tcp-check
3103 tcp-check connect port 110
3104 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3105 tcp-check connect port 143
3106 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3107 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
3108
3109 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
3110
3111
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003112tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
3113 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
3114 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3115 no | no | yes | yes
3116
3117 Arguments :
3118 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3119 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
3120 binary.
3121 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
3122 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
3123 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
3124
3125 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3126 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3127 with the usual backslash ('\').
3128 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
3129 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
3130 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
3131 used upper or lower case.
3132
3133
3134 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
3135
3136 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
3137 A health check response will be considered valid if the
3138 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
3139 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3140 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3141 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
3142 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
3143 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
3144
3145 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
3146 A health check response will be considered valid if the
3147 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
3148 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3149 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
3150 expression.
3151
3152 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
3153 in the response buffer. A health check response will
3154 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
3155 this exact hexadecimal string.
3156 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
3157
3158 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3159 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3160 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3161 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
3162 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3163 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3164 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3165 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
3166 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
3167 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
3168 the null character.
3169
3170 Examples :
3171 # perform a POP check
3172 option tcp-check
3173 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3174
3175 # perform an IMAP check
3176 option tcp-check
3177 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3178
3179 # look for the redis master server
3180 option tcp-check
3181 tcp-check send PING\r\n
3182 tcp-check expect +PONG
3183 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3184 tcp-check expect string role:master
3185 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
3186 tcp-check expect string +OK
3187
3188
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003189 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
3190 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003191
3192
3193tcp-check send <data>
3194 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3195 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3196 no | no | yes | yes
3197
3198 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3199 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3200
3201 Examples :
3202 # look for the redis master server
3203 option tcp-check
3204 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3205 tcp-check expect string role:master
3206
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003207 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
3208 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003209
3210
3211tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
3212 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
3213 tcp health check
3214 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3215 no | no | yes | yes
3216
3217 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3218 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3219 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
3220 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
3221 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
3222 hexadecimal string.
3223 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
3224
3225 Examples :
3226 # redis check in binary
3227 option tcp-check
3228 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
3229 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
3230
3231
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003232 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
3233 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003234
3235
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003236http-send-name-header [<header>]
3237 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3238
3239 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3240 yes | no | yes | yes
3241
3242 Arguments :
3243
3244 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3245
3246 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3247 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3248 is added with the header string proved.
3249
3250 See also : "server"
3251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003252id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003253 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3255 no | yes | yes | yes
3256 Arguments : none
3257
3258 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3259 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3260 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003261
3262
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003263ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3264 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3266 no | yes | yes | yes
3267
3268 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3269 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3270 and running).
3271
3272 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3273 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3274 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003275 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003276 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3277
3278 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3279 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3280
3281 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3282 "unless" condition is met.
3283
3284 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3285
3286
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003287log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003288log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003289no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003290 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3292 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003293
3294 Prefix :
3295 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3296 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3297 prefix does not allow arguments.
3298
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003299 Arguments :
3300 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3301 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3302 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3303 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3304 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3305 parameter.
3306
3307 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3308 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3309
3310 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3311 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3312 standard syslog port).
3313
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003314 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3315 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3316 standard syslog port).
3317
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003318 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3319 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3320 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3321 appropriately writeable).
3322
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003323 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3324 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3325 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3326 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3327
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003328 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3329
3330 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3331 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3332 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3333
3334 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3335 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3336 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003337 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3338 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3339 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3340 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3341 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003342
3343 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3344
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003345 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3346 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3347 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003348
3349 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3350 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3351 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3352 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3353
3354 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3355 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003356
3357 Example :
3358 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003359 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3360 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003361 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3362
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003363
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003364log-format <string>
3365 Allows you to custom a log line.
3366
3367 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3368
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003369
3370maxconn <conns>
3371 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3373 yes | yes | yes | no
3374 Arguments :
3375 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3376 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3377 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3378 closes.
3379
3380 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3381 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3382 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3383 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3384 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3385 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3386 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3387 properly tuned.
3388
3389 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3390 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3391 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3392
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003393 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3394
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003395 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3396
3397
3398mode { tcp|http|health }
3399 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3401 yes | yes | yes | yes
3402 Arguments :
3403 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3404 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3405 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3406 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3407
3408 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3409 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3410 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3411 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3412 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3413
3414 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003415 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3416 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3417 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3418 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3419 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3420 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3421 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003422
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003423 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3424 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3425 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003426
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003427 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003428 defaults http_instances
3429 mode http
3430
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003431 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003432
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003433
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003434monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003435 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3437 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003438 Arguments :
3439 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3440 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003441 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003442 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3443 backend and its backup.
3444
3445 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3446 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3447 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3448 servers in a list of backends.
3449
3450 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3451 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3452 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3453 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3454 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3455 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3456 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003457 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3458 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003459
3460 Example:
3461 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003462 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003463 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3464 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3465 monitor-uri /site_alive
3466 monitor fail if site_dead
3467
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003468 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003469
3470
3471monitor-net <source>
3472 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3474 yes | yes | yes | no
3475 Arguments :
3476 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3477 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3478 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3479 followed by a mask.
3480
3481 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3482 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003483 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003484 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3485
3486 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3487 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3488 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3489 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003490 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3491 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3492 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003493
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003494 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3495 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3496 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3497 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3498 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3499 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003500
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003501 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3502 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003503
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003504 Example :
3505 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3506 frontend www
3507 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3508
3509 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3510
3511
3512monitor-uri <uri>
3513 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3515 yes | yes | yes | no
3516 Arguments :
3517 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3518 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3519
3520 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3521 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3522 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3523 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3524 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3525 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3526 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3527 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3528
3529 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3530 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3531 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3532 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3533 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3534 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3535
3536 Example :
3537 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3538 frontend www
3539 mode http
3540 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3541
3542 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3543
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003544
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003545option abortonclose
3546no option abortonclose
3547 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3549 yes | no | yes | yes
3550 Arguments : none
3551
3552 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3553 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3554 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3555 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003556 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003557 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3558 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3559 encountered while delivering the response.
3560
3561 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3562 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3563 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3564 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3565 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3566 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003567 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003568 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003569 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003570 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3571 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3572 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3573
3574 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3575 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3576 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3577 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3578 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3579 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3580 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3581 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003582 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003583
3584 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3585 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3586
3587 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3588
3589
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003590option accept-invalid-http-request
3591no option accept-invalid-http-request
3592 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3594 yes | yes | yes | no
3595 Arguments : none
3596
3597 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3598 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3599 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3600 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3601 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3602 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3603 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3604 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003605 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3606 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3607 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3608 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3609 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3610 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003611
3612 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3613 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3614 been confirmed.
3615
3616 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3617 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003618 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3619 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003620 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3621
3622 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3623 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3624
3625 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3626 stats socket.
3627
3628
3629option accept-invalid-http-response
3630no option accept-invalid-http-response
3631 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3633 yes | no | yes | yes
3634 Arguments : none
3635
3636 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3637 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3638 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3639 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3640 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3641 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3642 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3643 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3644 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3645
3646 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3647 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3648 been confirmed.
3649
3650 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3651 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3652 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3653 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3654
3655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3657
3658 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3659 stats socket.
3660
3661
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003662option allbackups
3663no option allbackups
3664 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3666 yes | no | yes | yes
3667 Arguments : none
3668
3669 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3670 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3671 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3672 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3673 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3674 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3675 order between the backup servers anymore.
3676
3677 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3678 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3679
3680 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3681 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3682
3683
3684option checkcache
3685no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003686 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3688 yes | no | yes | yes
3689 Arguments : none
3690
3691 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3692 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003693 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003694 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3695 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003696 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003697
3698 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003699 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003700 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003701 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3702 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003703 to the client are :
3704 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003705 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003706 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003707 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3708 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3709 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3710 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3711 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3712 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3713 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3714 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3715 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3716 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3717 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3718
3719 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003720 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003721 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003722 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003723 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3724
3725 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3726 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003727 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003728 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3729
3730 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3731 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3732
3733
3734option clitcpka
3735no option clitcpka
3736 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3738 yes | yes | yes | no
3739 Arguments : none
3740
3741 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3742 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3743 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3744 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3745
3746 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3747 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3748 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3749 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3750
3751 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3752 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3753 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3754 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3755 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3756
3757 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3758
3759 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3760 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3761 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3762
3763 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3764 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3765
3766 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3767
3768
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003769option contstats
3770 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3772 yes | yes | yes | no
3773 Arguments : none
3774
3775 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3776 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3777 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3778 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3779 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3780 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3781 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3782
3783
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003784option dontlog-normal
3785no option dontlog-normal
3786 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3788 yes | yes | yes | no
3789 Arguments : none
3790
3791 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3792 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3793 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3794 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3795 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3796 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3797 logged.
3798
3799 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3800 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3801 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003803 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003804 logging.
3805
3806
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003807option dontlognull
3808no option dontlognull
3809 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3811 yes | yes | yes | no
3812 Arguments : none
3813
3814 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3815 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3816 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3817 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3818 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3819 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3820 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3821
3822 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3823 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3824 would not be logged.
3825
3826 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3827 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3828
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003829 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003830
3831
3832option forceclose
3833no option forceclose
3834 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003836 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003837 Arguments : none
3838
3839 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3840 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3841 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3842 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3843 global session times in the logs.
3844
3845 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003846 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003847 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003848
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003849 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3850 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3851 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3852
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003853 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3854 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003855
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003856 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3857 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3858
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003859 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003860
3861
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003862option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003863 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3865 yes | yes | yes | yes
3866 Arguments :
3867 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3868 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003869 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003870 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003871
3872 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3873 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3874 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3875 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3876 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3877 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3878 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003879 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3880 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3881 possible that the client has already brought one.
3882
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003883 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003884 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003885 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3886 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003887 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3888 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003889
3890 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3891 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3892 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3893 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3894 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3895 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3896 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3897
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003898 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3899 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3900 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3901 are under the control of the end-user.
3902
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003903 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003904 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3905 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003906 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3907 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3908 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003909
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003910 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003911 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3912 frontend www
3913 mode http
3914 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3915
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003916 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3917 backend www
3918 mode http
3919 option forwardfor header X-Client
3920
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003921 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003922 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003923
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003924
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003925option http-keep-alive
3926no option http-keep-alive
3927 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3929 yes | yes | yes | yes
3930 Arguments : none
3931
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003932 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3933 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3934 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
3935 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
3936 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3937 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
3938 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
3939
3940 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
3941 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003942 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3943 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3944 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3945 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3946 situations where this option may be useful :
3947
3948 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3949 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3950
3951 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3952 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3953
3954 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3955 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3956 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3957 request.
3958
3959 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3960 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003961 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3962 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3963 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003964
3965 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3966 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3967
3968 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3969 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3970 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3971 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3972 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3973 not set.
3974
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003975 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3976 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003977 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003978 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003979
3980 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003981 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3982 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003983
3984
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003985option http-no-delay
3986no option http-no-delay
3987 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3989 yes | yes | yes | yes
3990 Arguments : none
3991
3992 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3993 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3994 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3995 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3996 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3997 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3998 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3999 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4000 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4001 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4002 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4003 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4004 affected.
4005
4006 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4007 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4008 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4009 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4010 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4011 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4012 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4013 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4014 latency environments.
4015
4016
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004017option http-pretend-keepalive
4018no option http-pretend-keepalive
4019 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4021 yes | yes | yes | yes
4022 Arguments : none
4023
4024 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4025 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4026 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4027 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4028 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4029 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4030 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4031 consider the response complete.
4032
4033 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4034 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4035 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4036 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4037 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4038 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4039
4040 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4041 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4042 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4043 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4044 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4045 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4046 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4047
4048 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4049 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004050 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004051 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4052 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004053
4054 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4055 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4056
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004057 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4058 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004059
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004060
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004061option http-server-close
4062no option http-server-close
4063 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4065 yes | yes | yes | yes
4066 Arguments : none
4067
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004068 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4069 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4070 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4071 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4072 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4073 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4074 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4075 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4076 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4077 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4078 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4079 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4080 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4081 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4082 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4083 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004084
4085 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4086 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4087 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4088 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004089 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4090 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004091
4092 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4093 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004094 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4095 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004096 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4097 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004098
4099 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4100 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4101
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004102 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004103 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4104 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004105
4106
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004107option http-tunnel
4108no option http-tunnel
4109 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4111 yes | yes | yes | yes
4112 Arguments : none
4113
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004114 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4115 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4116 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4117 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4118 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4119 "option http-tunnel".
4120
4121 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004122 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004123 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4124 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4125 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4126 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4127 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4128 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4129 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004130
4131 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4132 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4133
4134 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4135 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4136 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4137
4138
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004139option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004140no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004141 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4143 yes | yes | yes | no
4144 Arguments : none
4145
4146 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4147 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4148 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4149 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4150 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4151 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4152 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4153
4154 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4155 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4156 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4157 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4158 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4159 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4160 request along its whole life.
4161
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004162 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4163 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4164 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4165 front of an existing proxy.
4166
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004167 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4168
4169 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4170 http-server-close".
4171
4172
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004173option httpchk
4174option httpchk <uri>
4175option httpchk <method> <uri>
4176option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4177 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4179 yes | no | yes | yes
4180 Arguments :
4181 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4182 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4183 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4184 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4185 ones.
4186
4187 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4188 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4189 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4190
4191 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4192 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4193 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4194 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4195 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4196
4197 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4198 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4199 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4200 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4201 the lack of any response.
4202
4203 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4204
4205 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4206 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4207 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4208
4209 Examples :
4210 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4211 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4212 backend https_relay
4213 mode tcp
4214 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4215 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4216
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004217 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4218 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4219 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004220
4221
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004222option httpclose
4223no option httpclose
4224 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4226 yes | yes | yes | yes
4227 Arguments : none
4228
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004229 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4230 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4231 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4232 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004233 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004234 "option http-tunnel".
4235
4236 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4237 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4238 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4239 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4240 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4241 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4242 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4243 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004244
4245 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004246 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004247 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4248 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4249 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4250 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4251 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004252
4253 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4254 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004255 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4256 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004257 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4258 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004259
4260 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4261 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4262
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004263 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4264 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004265
4266
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004267option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004268 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4270 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004271 Arguments :
4272 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4273 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4274 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4275 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4276 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004277
4278 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4279 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4280 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4281 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4282 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4283 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4284 ports.
4285
4286 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4287
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004288 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4289 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4290 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4291 by default.
4292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004293 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004294
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004295
4296option http_proxy
4297no option http_proxy
4298 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4300 yes | yes | yes | yes
4301 Arguments : none
4302
4303 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4304 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4305 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4306 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4307 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4308
4309 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4310 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4311 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4312 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004313 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004314 be analyzed.
4315
4316 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4317 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4318
4319 Example :
4320 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4321 backend direct_forward
4322 option httpclose
4323 option http_proxy
4324
4325 See also : "option httpclose"
4326
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004327
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004328option independent-streams
4329no option independent-streams
4330 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4332 yes | yes | yes | yes
4333 Arguments : none
4334
4335 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4336 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4337 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4338 receive data or not.
4339
4340 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4341 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4342 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4343 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4344 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4345 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4346 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4347 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4348 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4349 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4350 socket buffers.
4351
4352 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4353 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4354 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4355 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4356 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4357
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004358 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004359 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4360 deprecated.
4361
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004362 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004363
4364
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004365option ldap-check
4366 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4368 yes | no | yes | yes
4369 Arguments : none
4370
4371 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4372 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4373 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4374 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4375
4376 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4377 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4378
4379 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4380 configure it.
4381
4382 Example :
4383 option ldap-check
4384
4385 See also : "option httpchk"
4386
4387
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004388option log-health-checks
4389no option log-health-checks
4390 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4392 yes | no | yes | yes
4393 Arguments : none
4394
4395 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4396 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4397 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4398 of additional information is limited.
4399
4400 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4401 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4402
4403 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4404
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004405
4406option log-separate-errors
4407no option log-separate-errors
4408 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4410 yes | yes | yes | no
4411 Arguments : none
4412
4413 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4414 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4415 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4416 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4417 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4418 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4419 provides very important information.
4420
4421 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4422 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4423 error logs.
4424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004425 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004426 logging.
4427
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004428
4429option logasap
4430no option logasap
4431 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4433 yes | yes | yes | no
4434 Arguments : none
4435
4436 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4437 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4438 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4439 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4440 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4441 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4442 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004443 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004444 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4445 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4446
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004447 Examples :
4448 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4449 mode http
4450 option httplog
4451 option logasap
4452 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4453
4454 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4455 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4456 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4457 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4458
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004459 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004460 logging.
4461
4462
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004463option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4464 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4466 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004467 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004468 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4469 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004470
4471 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4472 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4473 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4474 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4475 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4476 in the MySQL table, like this :
4477
4478 USE mysql;
4479 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4480 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4481
4482 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4483 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4484 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4485 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4486 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4487 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4488 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4489 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4490 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4491
4492 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4493 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004494
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004495 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004496
4497 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4498 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4499 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4500 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4501 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4502 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4503
4504 See also: "option httpchk"
4505
4506
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004507option nolinger
4508no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004509 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004510 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4511 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004512 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004513
4514 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4515 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4516 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4517 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4518 connections.
4519
4520 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4521 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4522 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4523 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4524 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4525 this too.
4526
4527 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4528 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4529 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4530
4531 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4532 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4533 for servers.
4534
4535 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4536 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4537
4538
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004539option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4540 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4542 yes | yes | yes | yes
4543 Arguments :
4544 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4545 matching <network>
4546 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4547 header name.
4548
4549 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4550 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4551 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4552 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4553 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4554 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4555 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4556 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4557 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4558 possible that the client has already brought one.
4559
4560 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4561 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4562 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4563 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4564 header and requires different one.
4565
4566 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4567 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4568 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4569 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4570 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4571 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4572 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4573
4574 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4575 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4576 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4577 both are defined.
4578
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004579 Examples :
4580 # Original Destination address
4581 frontend www
4582 mode http
4583 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4584
4585 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4586 backend www
4587 mode http
4588 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4589
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004590 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4591 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004592
4593
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004594option persist
4595no option persist
4596 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4597 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4598 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004599 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004600
4601 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4602 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4603 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4604 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4605 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4606 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4607 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4608 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4609 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4610 redirected to another valid server.
4611
4612 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4613 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4614
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004615 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004616
4617
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004618option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4619 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4621 yes | no | yes | yes
4622 Arguments :
4623 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4624 PostgreSQL server.
4625
4626 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4627 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4628 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4629 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4630
4631 See also: "option httpchk"
4632
4633
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004634option prefer-last-server
4635no option prefer-last-server
4636 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4637 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4638 yes | no | yes | yes
4639 Arguments : none
4640
4641 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4642 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4643 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4644 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4645 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4646 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4647 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4648 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4649 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004650 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4651 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4652 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4653 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4654 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4655 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4656 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004657
4658 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4659 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4660
4661 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4662
4663
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004664option redispatch
4665no option redispatch
4666 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4667 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4668 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004669 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004670
4671 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4672 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4673 be able to access the service anymore.
4674
4675 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4676 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4677
4678 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4679 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4680 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004682 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4683 "redisp" keywords.
4684
4685 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4686 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4687
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004688 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004689
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004690
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004691option redis-check
4692 Use redis health checks for server testing
4693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4694 yes | no | yes | yes
4695 Arguments : none
4696
4697 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4698 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4699 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4700 find the "+PONG" response message.
4701
4702 Example :
4703 option redis-check
4704
4705 See also : "option httpchk"
4706
4707
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004708option smtpchk
4709option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4710 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4712 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004713 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004714 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4715 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4716 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4717
4718 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4719 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4720 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4721
4722 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4723 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4724 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4725 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4726 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4727 dead server.
4728
4729 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4730 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4731 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4732 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4733
4734 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4735 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4736 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4737 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4738 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4739
4740 Example :
4741 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4742
4743 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4744
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004746option socket-stats
4747no option socket-stats
4748
4749 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4751 yes | yes | yes | no
4752
4753 Arguments : none
4754
4755
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004756option splice-auto
4757no option splice-auto
4758 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4760 yes | yes | yes | yes
4761 Arguments : none
4762
4763 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4764 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4765 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4766 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004767 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004768 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4769 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4770 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4771 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4772
4773 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4774 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4775 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4776 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4777 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4778 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4779 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4780 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4781 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4782 keyword.
4783
4784 Example :
4785 option splice-auto
4786
4787 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4788 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4789
4790 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4791 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4792
4793
4794option splice-request
4795no option splice-request
4796 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4798 yes | yes | yes | yes
4799 Arguments : none
4800
4801 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004802 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004803 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4804 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4805 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4806 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4807
4808 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4809
4810 Example :
4811 option splice-request
4812
4813 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4814 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4815
4816 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4817 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4818
4819
4820option splice-response
4821no option splice-response
4822 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4824 yes | yes | yes | yes
4825 Arguments : none
4826
4827 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004828 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004829 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4830 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4831 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4832 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4833
4834 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4835
4836 Example :
4837 option splice-response
4838
4839 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4840 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4841
4842 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4843 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4844
4845
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004846option srvtcpka
4847no option srvtcpka
4848 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4850 yes | no | yes | yes
4851 Arguments : none
4852
4853 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4854 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4855 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4856 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4857
4858 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4859 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4860 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4861 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4862
4863 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4864 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4865 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4866 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4867 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4868
4869 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4870
4871 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4872 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4873 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4874
4875 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4876 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4877
4878 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4879
4880
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004881option ssl-hello-chk
4882 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4884 yes | no | yes | yes
4885 Arguments : none
4886
4887 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4888 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4889 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4890 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4891 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4892 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4893 hello message.
4894
4895 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4896 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4897 messages, which is appreciable.
4898
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004899 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4900 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4901 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004902
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004903 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4904
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004905
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004906option tcp-check
4907 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4908 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4909 yes | no | yes | yes
4910
4911 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4912 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4913
4914 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4915 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4916 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4917
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004918 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004919 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4920 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4921 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4922 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4923 only.
4924
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004925 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004926 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4927 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4928 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4929 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4930
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004931 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004932 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4933 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004934 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004935 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4936 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4937 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4938 the respective protocols.
4939 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4940 analysed.
4941
4942 Examples :
4943 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4944 option tcp-check
4945 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4946
4947 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4948 option tcp-check
4949 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4950
4951 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4952 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004953 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004954 option tcp-check
4955 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4956 tcp-check expect +PONG
4957 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4958 tcp-check expect string role:master
4959 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4960 tcp-check expect string +OK
4961
4962 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4963 (send many headers before analyzing)
4964 option tcp-check
4965 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4966 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4967 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4968 tcp-check send \r\n
4969 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4970
4971
4972 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4973
4974
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004975option tcp-smart-accept
4976no option tcp-smart-accept
4977 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4979 yes | yes | yes | no
4980 Arguments : none
4981
4982 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4983 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4984 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4985 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4986 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4987 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4988
4989 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4990 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4991 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4992 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4993
4994 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4995 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4996 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4997 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4998
4999 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5000 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5001 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5002
5003 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5004 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5005 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5006
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005007 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5008
5009
5010option tcp-smart-connect
5011no option tcp-smart-connect
5012 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5014 yes | no | yes | yes
5015 Arguments : none
5016
5017 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5018 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5019 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5020 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5021 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5022
5023 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5024 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5025 complex.
5026
5027 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5028 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5029 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5030
5031 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5032 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5033
5034 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5035
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005036
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005037option tcpka
5038 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5040 yes | yes | yes | yes
5041 Arguments : none
5042
5043 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5044 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5045 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5046 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5047
5048 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5049 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5050 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5051 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5052
5053 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5054 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5055 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5056 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5057 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5058
5059 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5060
5061 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5062 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5063 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5064 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5065 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5066 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5067 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5068 backends.
5069
5070 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5071
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005072
5073option tcplog
5074 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5076 yes | yes | yes | yes
5077 Arguments : none
5078
5079 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5080 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5081 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5082 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5083 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5084 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5085 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5086 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5087
5088 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005090 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005091
5092
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005093option transparent
5094no option transparent
5095 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005097 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005098 Arguments : none
5099
5100 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5101 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5102 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5103 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5104 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5105 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5106 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5107 appropriate server.
5108
5109 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5110 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5111
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005112 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005113 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005114
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005115
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005116persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005117persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005118 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5120 yes | no | yes | yes
5121 Arguments :
5122 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005123 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5124 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005125
5126 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5127 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5128 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5129 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5130 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5131 forwarded to this server.
5132
5133 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5134 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5135 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005136 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005137 a single "listen" section.
5138
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005139 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5140 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5141 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5142
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005143 Example :
5144 listen tse-farm
5145 bind :3389
5146 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5147 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5148 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5149 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5150 persist rdp-cookie
5151 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005152 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005153 balance rdp-cookie
5154 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5155 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5156
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005157 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5158 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005159
5160
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005161rate-limit sessions <rate>
5162 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5164 yes | yes | yes | no
5165 Arguments :
5166 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5167 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5168
5169 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5170 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5171 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5172 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5173 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5174 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5175
5176 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5177 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5178 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5179 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5180
5181 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5182 listen smtp
5183 mode tcp
5184 bind :25
5185 rate-limit sessions 10
5186 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5187
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005188 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5189 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5190 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005191
5192 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5193
5194
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005195redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5196redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5197redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005198 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5200 no | yes | yes | yes
5201
5202 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005203 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005204
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005205 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005206 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005207 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5208 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5209 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005210
5211 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5212 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5213 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5214 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5215 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005216 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5217 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5218 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5219 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005220
5221 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5222 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5223 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5224 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5225 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5226 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005227 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005228 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005229 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5230 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5231 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005232
5233 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005234 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5235 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5236 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5237 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5238 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5239 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5240 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5241 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005242
5243 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5244 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5245
5246 - "drop-query"
5247 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5248 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5249 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5250 with a location-type redirect.
5251
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005252 - "append-slash"
5253 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5254 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5255 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5256 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5257
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005258 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5259 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5260 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5261 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5262 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5263 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5264 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5265
5266 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5267 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5268 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5269 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5270 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5271 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5272 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005273
5274 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5275 acl clear dst_port 80
5276 acl secure dst_port 8080
5277 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005278 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005279 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005280 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5281
5282 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005283 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5284 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5285 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005286 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005287
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005288 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5289 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5290 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5291
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005292 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005293 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005294
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005295 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5296 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5297 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005299 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005300
5301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005302redisp (deprecated)
5303redispatch (deprecated)
5304 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5305 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5306 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005307 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005308
5309 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5310 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5311 be able to access the service anymore.
5312
5313 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5314 redistribute them to a working server.
5315
5316 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5317 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5318 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005320 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5321 "option redispatch" instead.
5322
5323 See also : "option redispatch"
5324
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005325
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005326reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005327 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5329 no | yes | yes | yes
5330 Arguments :
5331 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5332 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005333 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005334
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005335 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5336 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5337
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005338 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5339 the last header of an HTTP request.
5340
5341 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5342 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5343 responses.
5344
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005345 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5346 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5347 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5348
5349 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5350 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005351
5352
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005353reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5354reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005355 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5357 no | yes | yes | yes
5358 Arguments :
5359 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5360 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5361 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5362 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5363 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5364 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5365 ignores case.
5366
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005367 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5368 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5369
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005370 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5371 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5372 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5373 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005374 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005375
5376 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5377 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5378
5379 Example :
5380 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5381 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5382 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5383
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005384 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5385 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005386
5387
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005388reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5389reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005390 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5392 no | yes | yes | yes
5393 Arguments :
5394 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5395 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5396 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5397 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5398 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5399 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5400
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005401 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5402 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5403
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005404 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5405 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5406 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5407 next servers.
5408
5409 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5410 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5411 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5412
5413 Example :
5414 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5415 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5416 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5417
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005418 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5419 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005420
5421
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005422reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5423reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005424 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5426 no | yes | yes | yes
5427 Arguments :
5428 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5429 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5430 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5431 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5432 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5433 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5434 case.
5435
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005436 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5437 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5438
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005439 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5440 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5441 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5442 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005443 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005444
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005445 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005446 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005447 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005448
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005449 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5450 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5451
5452 Example :
5453 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5454 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5455 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5456
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005457 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5458 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005459
5460
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005461reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5462reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005463 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5465 no | yes | yes | yes
5466 Arguments :
5467 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5468 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5469 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5470 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5471 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5472 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5473 case.
5474
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005475 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5476 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5477
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005478 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5479 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5480 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5481 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5482
5483 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5484 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5485
5486 Example :
5487 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5488 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5489 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5490 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5491
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005492 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5493 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005494
5495
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005496reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5497reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005498 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5500 no | yes | yes | yes
5501 Arguments :
5502 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5503 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5504 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5505 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5506 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5507 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5508
5509 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5510 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5511 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5512 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005513 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005514
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005515 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5516 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5517
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005518 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5519 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5520 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5521
5522 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5523 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5524 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5525 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5526 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5527
5528 Example :
5529 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005530 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005531 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5532 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5533
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005534 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5535 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005536
5537
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005538reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5539reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005540 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5542 no | yes | yes | yes
5543 Arguments :
5544 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5545 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5546 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5547 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5548 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5549 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5550 ignores case.
5551
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005552 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5553 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5554
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005555 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5556 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005557 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5558 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5559 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005560 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5561 not set.
5562
5563 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5564 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5565 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5566 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5567 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5568
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005569 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005570 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5571 # block all others.
5572 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5573 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5574
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005575 # block bad guys
5576 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5577 reqitarpit . if badguys
5578
5579 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5580 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005581
5582
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005583retries <value>
5584 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5585 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5586 yes | no | yes | yes
5587 Arguments :
5588 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5589 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5590 default value is 3.
5591
5592 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5593 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5594 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5595
5596 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5597 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5598
5599 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5600 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5601
5602 See also : "option redispatch"
5603
5604
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005605rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005606 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5608 no | yes | yes | yes
5609 Arguments :
5610 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5611 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005612 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005613
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005614 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5615 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5616
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005617 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5618 the last header of an HTTP response.
5619
5620 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5621 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5622 responses.
5623
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005624 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5625 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005626
5627
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005628rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5629rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005630 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5632 no | yes | yes | yes
5633 Arguments :
5634 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5635 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5636 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5637 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5638 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5639 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5640 ignores case.
5641
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005642 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5643 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5644
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005645 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5646 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005647 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005648 client.
5649
5650 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5651 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5652 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5653
5654 Example :
5655 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005656 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005657
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005658 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5659 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005660
5661
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005662rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5663rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005664 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5666 no | yes | yes | yes
5667 Arguments :
5668 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5669 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5670 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5671 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5672 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5673 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5674 ignores case.
5675
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005676 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5677 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5678
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005679 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5680 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5681 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5682 case-sensitive.
5683
5684 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005685 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5686 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5687 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005688
5689 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5690 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5691
5692 Example :
5693 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5694 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5695
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005696 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5697 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005698
5699
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005700rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5701rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005702 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5704 no | yes | yes | yes
5705 Arguments :
5706 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5707 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5708 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5709 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5710 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5711 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5712 ignores case.
5713
5714 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5715 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5716 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5717 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005718 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005719
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005720 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5721 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5722
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005723 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5724 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5725 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5726
5727 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5728 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5729 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5730 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5731 are not case-sensitive.
5732
5733 Example :
5734 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5735 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5736
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005737 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5738 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005739
5740
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005741server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005742 Declare a server in a backend
5743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5744 no | no | yes | yes
5745 Arguments :
5746 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005747 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005748 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005749
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005750 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5751 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5752 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5753 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005754 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5755 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5756 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5757 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5758 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005759 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5760 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5761 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5762 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5763 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5764 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5765 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005766 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5767 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5768 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5769 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005770
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005771 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005772 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5773 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5774 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5775 adding this value to the client's port.
5776
5777 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5778 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005779 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005780
5781 Examples :
5782 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5783 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005784 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005785 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5786 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5787 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005788
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005789 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5790 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005791
5792
5793source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005794source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005795source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005796 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5798 yes | no | yes | yes
5799 Arguments :
5800 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5801 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005802
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005803 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005804 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5805 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5806 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5807 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5808 supported prefixes are :
5809 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5810 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5811 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005812 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5813 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5814 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5815 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005816
5817 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5818 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005819 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5820 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5821 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005822
5823 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5824 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5825 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5826 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5827 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5828 <addr>.
5829
5830 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5831 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5832 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5833 port.
5834
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005835 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5836 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5837 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5838 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005839 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005840 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5841 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5842 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5843 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5844 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5845 HTTP header.
5846
5847 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5848 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005849 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005850 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5851 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5852 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5853 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5854 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5855 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5856 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5857
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005858 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5859 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5860 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5861 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5862 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5863 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5864
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005865 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5866 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5867 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5868 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5869
5870 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5871 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5872 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5873 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5874 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5875 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5876
5877 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5878 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5879 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5880 there are two methods :
5881
5882 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5883 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5884 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5885 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5886 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5887 of the client ranges may be used.
5888
5889 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5890 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5891 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5892 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5893 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5894 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5895 same session.
5896
5897 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5898 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5899 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5900 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5901 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5902 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5903
5904 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5905 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5906 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005907 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005908
5909 Examples :
5910 backend private
5911 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5912 source 192.168.1.200
5913
5914 backend transparent_ssl1
5915 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5916 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5917
5918 backend transparent_ssl2
5919 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5920 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5921 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5922
5923 backend transparent_ssl3
5924 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5925 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5926 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5927
5928 backend transparent_smtp
5929 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5930 # with Tproxy version 4.
5931 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5932
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005933 backend transparent_http
5934 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5935 # proxy.
5936 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005938 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005939 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5940
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005941
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005942srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5943 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5945 yes | no | yes | yes
5946 Arguments :
5947 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5948 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5949 as explained at the top of this document.
5950
5951 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5952 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5953 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5954 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5955 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5956 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5957 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5958
5959 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5960 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5961 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5962 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5963 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005964 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005965 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005966 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005967
5968 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5969 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5970 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5971 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5972 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5973 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5974
5975 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5976 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5977
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005978 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5979 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005980
5981
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005982stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5983 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5985 no | no | yes | yes
5986
5987 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5988 matched.
5989
5990 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5991 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5992
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005993 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5994 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5995 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5996
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005997 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5998 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5999 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6000 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006001
6002 Example :
6003 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6004 backend stats_localhost
6005 stats enable
6006 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6007
6008 Example :
6009 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6010 backend stats_auth
6011 stats enable
6012 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6013 stats admin if TRUE
6014
6015 Example :
6016 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6017 userlist stats-auth
6018 group admin users admin
6019 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6020 group readonly users haproxy
6021 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6022
6023 backend stats_auth
6024 stats enable
6025 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6026 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6027 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6028 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6029
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006030 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6031 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6032 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006033
6034
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006035stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6036 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6038 yes | no | yes | yes
6039 Arguments :
6040 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6041
6042 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6043
6044 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6045 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6046 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6047 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6048 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6049 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6050
6051 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6052 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6053 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006054 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006055
6056 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6057 report using "stats scope".
6058
6059 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6060 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6061 unobvious parameters.
6062
6063 Example :
6064 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6065 backend public_www
6066 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6067 stats enable
6068 stats hide-version
6069 stats scope .
6070 stats uri /admin?stats
6071 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6072 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6073 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6074
6075 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6076 backend private_monitoring
6077 stats enable
6078 stats uri /admin?stats
6079 stats refresh 5s
6080
6081 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6082
6083
6084stats enable
6085 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6087 yes | no | yes | yes
6088 Arguments : none
6089
6090 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6091 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6092 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6093 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6094 - stats auth : no authentication
6095 - stats scope : no restriction
6096
6097 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6098 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6099 unobvious parameters.
6100
6101 Example :
6102 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6103 backend public_www
6104 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6105 stats enable
6106 stats hide-version
6107 stats scope .
6108 stats uri /admin?stats
6109 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6110 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6111 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6112
6113 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6114 backend private_monitoring
6115 stats enable
6116 stats uri /admin?stats
6117 stats refresh 5s
6118
6119 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6120
6121
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006122stats hide-version
6123 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6125 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006126 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006127
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006128 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6129 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6130 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6131 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6132 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6133 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006135 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6136 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6137 unobvious parameters.
6138
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006139 Example :
6140 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6141 backend public_www
6142 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006143 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006144 stats hide-version
6145 stats scope .
6146 stats uri /admin?stats
6147 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6148 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6149 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006150
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006151 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6152 backend private_monitoring
6153 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006154 stats uri /admin?stats
6155 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006156
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006157 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006158
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006159
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006160stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6161 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6162 Access control for statistics
6163
6164 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6165 no | no | yes | yes
6166
6167 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6168 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6169 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6170 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6171 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6172 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6173
6174 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6175 instance.
6176
6177 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6178 about ACL usage.
6179
6180
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006181stats realm <realm>
6182 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6184 yes | no | yes | yes
6185 Arguments :
6186 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6187 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6188 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6189
6190 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6191 using a backslash ('\').
6192
6193 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6194 only related to authentication.
6195
6196 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6197 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6198 unobvious parameters.
6199
6200 Example :
6201 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6202 backend public_www
6203 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6204 stats enable
6205 stats hide-version
6206 stats scope .
6207 stats uri /admin?stats
6208 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6209 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6210 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6211
6212 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6213 backend private_monitoring
6214 stats enable
6215 stats uri /admin?stats
6216 stats refresh 5s
6217
6218 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6219
6220
6221stats refresh <delay>
6222 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6224 yes | no | yes | yes
6225 Arguments :
6226 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6227 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6228 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6229 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6230 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6231 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6232
6233 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6234 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6235 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6236 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6237
6238 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6239 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6240 unobvious parameters.
6241
6242 Example :
6243 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6244 backend public_www
6245 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6246 stats enable
6247 stats hide-version
6248 stats scope .
6249 stats uri /admin?stats
6250 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6251 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6252 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6253
6254 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6255 backend private_monitoring
6256 stats enable
6257 stats uri /admin?stats
6258 stats refresh 5s
6259
6260 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6261
6262
6263stats scope { <name> | "." }
6264 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6266 yes | no | yes | yes
6267 Arguments :
6268 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6269 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6270 section in which the statement appears.
6271
6272 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6273 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6274 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6275 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6276 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6277 exists.
6278
6279 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6280 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6281 unobvious parameters.
6282
6283 Example :
6284 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6285 backend public_www
6286 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6287 stats enable
6288 stats hide-version
6289 stats scope .
6290 stats uri /admin?stats
6291 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6292 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6293 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6294
6295 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6296 backend private_monitoring
6297 stats enable
6298 stats uri /admin?stats
6299 stats refresh 5s
6300
6301 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6302
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006303
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006304stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006305 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6307 yes | no | yes | yes
6308
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006309 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006310 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6311
6312 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6313 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6314
6315 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6316 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006317 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006318
6319 Example :
6320 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6321 backend private_monitoring
6322 stats enable
6323 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6324 stats uri /admin?stats
6325 stats refresh 5s
6326
6327 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6328 global section.
6329
6330
6331stats show-legends
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006332 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006333 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6334 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6335 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6336 - IP (socket, server)
6337 - cookie (backend, server)
6338
6339 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6340 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006341 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006342
6343 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6344
6345
6346stats show-node [ <name> ]
6347 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6349 yes | no | yes | yes
6350 Arguments:
6351 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6352 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6353
6354 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6355 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006356 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006357
6358 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6359 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6360 unobvious parameters.
6361
6362 Example:
6363 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6364 backend private_monitoring
6365 stats enable
6366 stats show-node Europe-1
6367 stats uri /admin?stats
6368 stats refresh 5s
6369
6370 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6371 section.
6372
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006373
6374stats uri <prefix>
6375 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6377 yes | no | yes | yes
6378 Arguments :
6379 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6380 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6381 query string.
6382
6383 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6384 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6385 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6386 possible to reach it in the application.
6387
6388 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006389 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006390 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6391 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6392 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6393 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6394
6395 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6396 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6397 an address or a port to statistics only.
6398
6399 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6400 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6401 unobvious parameters.
6402
6403 Example :
6404 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6405 backend public_www
6406 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6407 stats enable
6408 stats hide-version
6409 stats scope .
6410 stats uri /admin?stats
6411 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6412 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6413 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6414
6415 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6416 backend private_monitoring
6417 stats enable
6418 stats uri /admin?stats
6419 stats refresh 5s
6420
6421 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6422
6423
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006424stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6425 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006427 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006428
6429 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006430 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006431 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6432 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6433 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6434
6435 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6436 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6437 the "stick-table" statement.
6438
6439 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6440 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6441 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6442 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6443 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6444
6445 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6446 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6447 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6448 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6449 transformation rules.
6450
6451 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6452 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6453 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6454 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6455 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6456 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6457 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6458
6459 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6460 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6461 ACL based conditions.
6462
6463 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6464 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6465 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6466 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6467
6468 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6469 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6470 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6471 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6472
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006473 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6474 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6475 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6476
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006477 Example :
6478 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6479 # last 30 minutes
6480 backend pop
6481 mode tcp
6482 balance roundrobin
6483 stick store-request src
6484 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6485 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6486 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6487
6488 backend smtp
6489 mode tcp
6490 balance roundrobin
6491 stick match src table pop
6492 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6493 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6494
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006495 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6496 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006497
6498
6499stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6500 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6502 no | no | yes | yes
6503
6504 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6505 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6506 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6507 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6508
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006509 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6510 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6511 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6512
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006513 Examples :
6514 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006515 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006516
6517 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6518 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6519 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6520
6521
6522 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6523 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6524 backend http
6525 mode http
6526 balance roundrobin
6527 stick on src table https
6528 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6529 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6530 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6531
6532 backend https
6533 mode tcp
6534 balance roundrobin
6535 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6536 stick on src
6537 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6538 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6539
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006540 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006541
6542
6543stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6544 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6546 no | no | yes | yes
6547
6548 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006549 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006550 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6551 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6552 server is selected.
6553
6554 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6555 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6556 the "stick-table" statement.
6557
6558 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6559 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6560 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6561 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6562 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6563 address.
6564
6565 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6566 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6567 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6568 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6569 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6570 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6571 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6572 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6573 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6574 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6575
6576 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6577 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6578 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6579 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6580 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6581 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6582 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6583
6584 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6585 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6586 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6587 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6588
6589 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6590 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6591 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6592 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6593 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6594 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006595 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6596 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6597 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6598 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6599 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6600 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006601
6602 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6603 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6604 the request.
6605
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006606 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6607 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6608 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6609
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006610 Example :
6611 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6612 # last 30 minutes
6613 backend pop
6614 mode tcp
6615 balance roundrobin
6616 stick store-request src
6617 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6618 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6619 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6620
6621 backend smtp
6622 mode tcp
6623 balance roundrobin
6624 stick match src table pop
6625 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6626 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6627
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006628 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6629 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006630
6631
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006632stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006633 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6634 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006635 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006637 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006638
6639 Arguments :
6640 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6641 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6642 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6643 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6644
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006645 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6646 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6647 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6648 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6649
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006650 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6651 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6652 instance.
6653
6654 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6655 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6656 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6657 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6658 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6659 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006660 to 32 characters.
6661
6662 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6663 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6664 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6665 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6666 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6667 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006668
6669 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006670 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6671 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006672 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6673 increase.
6674
6675 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006676 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6677 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6678 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006679
6680 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6681 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6682 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6683 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6684 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6685 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6686 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6687 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6688 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6689 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6690 parameter (see below).
6691
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006692 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6693 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6694 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6695 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6696 soft restart.
6697
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006698 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6699
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006700 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6701 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6702 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6703 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6704 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006705 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006706 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6707 if not expiration delay is specified.
6708
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006709 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6710 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6711 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6712 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006713 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6714 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6715 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6716 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6717 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6718 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6719 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6720 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6721 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6722 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6723 types and their arguments.
6724
6725 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6726 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6727 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6728 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6729
6730 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6731 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6732 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6733 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6734
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006735 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6736 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6737 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6738 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6739 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6740 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6741
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006742 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6743 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6744 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6745 they were received.
6746
6747 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6748 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6749 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6750 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6751 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6752
6753 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6754 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6755 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6756 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6757 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6758
6759 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6760 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6761 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6762
6763 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6764 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6765 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6766 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6767 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6768
6769 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6770 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6771 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6772 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6773 the client side.
6774
6775 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6776 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6777 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6778 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6779 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6780 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6781 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6782
6783 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6784 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6785 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6786 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6787 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6788 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6789 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6790
6791 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6792 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6793 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6794 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6795 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6796 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6797
6798 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6799 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6800 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6801 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6802
6803 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6804 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6805 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6806 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6807 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6808 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6809 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6810 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6811 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6812 recommended for better fairness.
6813
6814 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6815 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6816 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6817 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6818
6819 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6820 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6821 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6822 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6823 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6824 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6825 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6826 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6827 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6828 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006829
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006830 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6831 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006832 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6833 reference it.
6834
6835 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6836 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6837 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6838 as an exclusive stickiness.
6839
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006840 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6841 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6842 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6843 something that can be ignored.
6844
6845 Example:
6846 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6847 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6848 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6849 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6850
6851 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006852 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006853
6854
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006855stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6856 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6858 no | no | yes | yes
6859
6860 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006861 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006862 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6863 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6864 server is selected.
6865
6866 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6867 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6868 the "stick-table" statement.
6869
6870 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6871 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6872 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6873 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6874
6875 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6876 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6877 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6878 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6879 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6880 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006881 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006882 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6883 rules.
6884
6885 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6886 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6887 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6888 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6889 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6890 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6891 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6892
6893 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6894 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6895 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6896 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6897
6898 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6899 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6900 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6901 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6902 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6903 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006904 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6905 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6906 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6907 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6908 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6909 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6910 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6911 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6912 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006913
6914 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6915
6916 Example :
6917 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6918 backend https
6919 mode tcp
6920 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006921 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006922 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006923
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006924 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6925 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6926
6927 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6928 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6929 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6930
6931 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6932 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006933
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006934 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6935 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6936 # at offset 44.
6937
6938 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6939 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6940
6941 # Learn on response if server hello.
6942 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006943
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006944 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6945 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6946
6947 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6948 extraction.
6949
6950
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006951tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6952 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6954 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006955 Arguments :
6956 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006957 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6958 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006959
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006960 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006961
6962 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6963 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006964 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6965 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6966 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6967 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6968 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6969 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006970
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006971 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6972 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6973 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6974 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006975
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006976 Three types of actions are supported :
6977 - accept :
6978 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6979 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6980 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006981
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006982 - reject :
6983 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6984 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6985 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6986 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6987 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6988 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6989 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6990 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6991 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6992 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6993 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6994 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006995
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006996 - expect-proxy layer4 :
6997 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
6998 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
6999 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7000 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7001 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7002 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7003 hosts.
7004
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007005 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007006 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7007 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7008 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007009 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7010 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007011 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007012 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7013 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7014 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7015 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7016 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007018 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007019 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007020 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007021 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7022 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7023 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7024 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007025
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007026 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7027 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7028 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7029 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007030
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007031 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7032 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7033 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7034 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7035 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007036 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7037 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7038 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7039 layer7 information is extracted.
7040
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007041 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7042 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7043 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7044 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7045 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007046
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007047 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7048 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7049 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007050
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007051 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7052 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7053 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007054
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007055 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007056 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007057 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007058
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007059 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7060 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7061 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007062
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007063 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007064 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7065 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007066
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007067 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7068
7069 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7070
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007071 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7072
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007073 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007074
7075
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007076tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7077 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007079 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007080 Arguments :
7081 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007082 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7083 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02007084 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007085
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007086 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007087
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007088 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7089 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7090 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7091 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7092 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007093
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007094 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7095 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7096 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7097 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007098 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7099 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7100 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7101 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7102 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7103 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007104 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007105 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007106
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007107 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7108 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7109 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7110 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007112 Three types of actions are supported :
7113 - accept :
7114 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007115 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007116
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007117 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7118 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007119
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007120 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7121 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7122 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7123 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7124 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7125 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007127 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007128 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7129 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007130
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007131 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007132 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7133 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7134 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7135 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007136 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7137 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7138 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007139
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007140 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7141 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7142 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7143 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7144
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007145 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007146 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7147 # and reject everything else.
7148 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7149 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007150 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007151 tcp-request content reject
7152
7153 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007154 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7155 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7156 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007157 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007158
7159 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7160 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7161 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007162 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007163 tcp-request content reject
7164
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007165 Example:
7166 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7167 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007168 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007169
7170 Example:
7171 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7172 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007173 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007174
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007175 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7176 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7177
7178 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007179 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007180 # protecting all our sites
7181 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007182 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7183 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007184 ...
7185 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7186
7187 backend http_dynamic
7188 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007189 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007190 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007191 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7192 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7193 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007194 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007196 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007197
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007198 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007199
7200
7201tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7202 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007204 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007205 Arguments :
7206 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7207 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7208 as explained at the top of this document.
7209
7210 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7211 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7212 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7213 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7214 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7215
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007216 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7217 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7218 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7219 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7220
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007221 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7222 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007223 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007224 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007225 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7226 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7227 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7228 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007229
7230 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7231 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7232 it pass through unaffected.
7233
7234 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7235 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7236 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007237 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007238 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7239 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007240 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7241 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7242 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007243
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007244 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007245 "timeout client".
7246
7247
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007248tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7249 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7251 no | no | yes | yes
7252 Arguments :
7253 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007254 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007255
7256 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7257
7258 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7259 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7260 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007261 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7262 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007263
7264 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7265
7266 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7267 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7268 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7269 inserted.
7270
7271 Two types of actions are supported :
7272 - accept :
7273 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7274 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7275 the rules evaluation.
7276
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007277 - close :
7278 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7279 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7280 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7281 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7282 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7283 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007284 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007285 protocols.
7286
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007287 - reject :
7288 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7289 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007290 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007291
7292 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7293 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7294 for changing the default action to a reject.
7295
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007296 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7297 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7298 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7299 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007300 period.
7301
7302 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7303
7304 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7305
7306
7307tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7308 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7310 no | no | yes | yes
7311 Arguments :
7312 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7313 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7314 as explained at the top of this document.
7315
7316 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7317
7318
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007319timeout check <timeout>
7320 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7321 established.
7322
7323 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7324 yes | no | yes | yes
7325 Arguments:
7326 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7327 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7328 as explained at the top of this document.
7329
7330 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7331 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7332 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7333 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007334 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7335 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7336 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007337
7338 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7339 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7340
7341 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7342 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007343 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007344
7345 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7346 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7347 forget about it.
7348
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007349 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7350 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007351
7352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007353timeout client <timeout>
7354timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7355 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7357 yes | yes | yes | no
7358 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007359 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007360 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7361 as explained at the top of this document.
7362
7363 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7364 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7365 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7366 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7367 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7368 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7369 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7370 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007371 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007372 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007373 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7374 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
7375 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007376
7377 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7378 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7379 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7380 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7381 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7382 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7383
7384 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7385 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7386 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7387
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007388 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007389
7390
7391timeout connect <timeout>
7392timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7393 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7395 yes | no | yes | yes
7396 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007397 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007398 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7399 as explained at the top of this document.
7400
7401 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007402 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007403 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007404 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007405 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7406 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007407
7408 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7409 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7410 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7411 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7412 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7413 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7414
7415 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7416 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7417 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7418
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007419 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7420 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007421
7422
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007423timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7424 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7426 yes | yes | yes | yes
7427 Arguments :
7428 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7429 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7430 as explained at the top of this document.
7431
7432 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7433 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7434 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7435 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7436 once the request has started to present itself.
7437
7438 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7439 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7440 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7441 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7442 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7443
7444 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7445 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7446 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7447 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7448
7449 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7450 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7451 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7452 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7453 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007454 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007455
7456 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7457 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7458 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7459 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7460
7461 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7462
7463
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007464timeout http-request <timeout>
7465 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007467 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007468 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007469 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007470 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7471 as explained at the top of this document.
7472
7473 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7474 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7475 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7476 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7477 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7478 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7479 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7480 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7481
7482 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7483 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007484 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7485 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007486
7487 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7488 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7489 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7490 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7491 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7492
7493 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007494 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7495 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7496 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007497
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007498 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007499
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007500
7501timeout queue <timeout>
7502 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7504 yes | no | yes | yes
7505 Arguments :
7506 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7507 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7508 as explained at the top of this document.
7509
7510 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7511 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7512 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7513 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7514 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7515
7516 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7517 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7518 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7519 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7520
7521 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7522
7523
7524timeout server <timeout>
7525timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7526 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7528 yes | no | yes | yes
7529 Arguments :
7530 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7531 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7532 as explained at the top of this document.
7533
7534 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7535 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7536 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7537 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7538 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7539 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7540 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7541
7542 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7543 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7544 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7545 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7546 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007547 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007548 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007549 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7550 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7551 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7552 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007553
7554 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7555 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7556 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7557 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7558 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7559 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7560
7561 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7562 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7563 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7564
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007565 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007566
7567
7568timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007569 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7571 yes | yes | yes | yes
7572 Arguments :
7573 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7574 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7575 as explained at the top of this document.
7576
7577 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7578 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7579 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7580
7581 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7582 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7583 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7584 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007585 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007586
7587 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7588
7589
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007590timeout tunnel <timeout>
7591 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7593 yes | no | yes | yes
7594 Arguments :
7595 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7596 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7597 as explained at the top of this document.
7598
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007599 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007600 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7601 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7602 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7603 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7604 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7605 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7606 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7607 specified.
7608
7609 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7610 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7611 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7612 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7613 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7614
7615 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7616 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7617 forget about it.
7618
7619 Example :
7620 defaults http
7621 option http-server-close
7622 timeout connect 5s
7623 timeout client 30s
7624 timeout client 30s
7625 timeout server 30s
7626 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7627
7628 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7629
7630
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007631transparent (deprecated)
7632 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007634 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007635 Arguments : none
7636
7637 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7638 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7639 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7640 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7641 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7642 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7643 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7644 appropriate server.
7645
7646 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7647
7648 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7649 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7650
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007651 See also: "option transparent"
7652
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007653unique-id-format <string>
7654 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7656 yes | yes | yes | no
7657 Arguments :
7658 <string> is a log-format string.
7659
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007660 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7661 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7662 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7663 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007664
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007665 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7666 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7667 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7668 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7669 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7670 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7671 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7672 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007673
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007674 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7675 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007676
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007677 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007678
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007679 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007680
7681 will generate:
7682
7683 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7684
7685 See also: "unique-id-header"
7686
7687unique-id-header <name>
7688 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7690 yes | yes | yes | no
7691 Arguments :
7692 <name> is the name of the header.
7693
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007694 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7695 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007696
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007697 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007698
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007699 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007700 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7701
7702 will generate:
7703
7704 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7705
7706 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007707
7708use_backend <backend> if <condition>
7709use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007710 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7712 no | yes | yes | no
7713 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007714 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
7715 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007717 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007718
7719 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7720 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7721 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007722 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7723 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7724 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7725 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007726
7727 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7728 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7729 assign the backend.
7730
7731 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7732 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7733 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7734 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7735 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7736 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7737
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007738 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007739 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007740 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7741 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7742 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7743
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007744 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
7745 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
7746 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
7747 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
7748 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
7749 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
7750 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
7751 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
7752 cannot be forced from the request.
7753
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007754 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007755 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
7756 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
7757
7758 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
7759 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007760
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007761
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007762use-server <server> if <condition>
7763use-server <server> unless <condition>
7764 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7766 no | no | yes | yes
7767 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007768 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007769
7770 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7771
7772 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7773 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7774 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7775
7776 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7777 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7778 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7779 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7780 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7781 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7782 matches will assign the server.
7783
7784 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7785 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7786 with the next rules until one matches.
7787
7788 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7789 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7790 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7791 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7792
7793 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7794 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7795 stripped.
7796
7797 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7798 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7799 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7800 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7801
7802 Example :
7803 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7804 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7805 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7806 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7807 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7808 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7809 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7810 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7811 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7812
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007813 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007814
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007815
78165. Bind and Server options
7817--------------------------
7818
7819The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7820depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7821settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7822written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7823described in this section.
7824
7825
78265.1. Bind options
7827-----------------
7828
7829The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7830as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7831no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7832parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7833while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7834provided immediately after the setting name.
7835
7836The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7837
7838accept-proxy
7839 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7840 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7841 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7842 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7843 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7844 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7845 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7846 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7847 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007848 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7849 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007850
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007851alpn <protocols>
7852 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7853 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7854 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7855 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7856 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7857 initial NPN extension.
7858
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007859backlog <backlog>
7860 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7861 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7862
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007863ecdhe <named curve>
7864 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007865 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7866 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007867
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007868ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007869 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7870 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7871 client's certificate.
7872
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007873ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7874 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7875 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7876 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7877 error is ignored.
7878
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007879ciphers <ciphers>
7880 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7881 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007882 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007883 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7884 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7885
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007886crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7888 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7889 to verify client's certificate.
7890
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007891crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007892 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7893 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7894 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7895 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7896 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7897 file.
7898
7899 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7900 are loaded.
7901
7902 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7903 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7904 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7905 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7906 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7907 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7908 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7909 www.sub.example.org).
7910
7911 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7912 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7913 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7914 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7915 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7916
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007917 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007918
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007919 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7920 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08007921 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007922 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7923 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7924 clients).
7925
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007926crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007927 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7928 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007929 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007930 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007931
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007932crt-list <file>
7933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007934 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7935 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007936
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007937 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007938
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007939 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7940 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7941 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7942 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7943 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7944 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7945 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7946 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007947
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007948defer-accept
7949 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7950 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7951 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7952 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7953 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7954 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7955 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7956 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7957 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7958 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7959 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7960
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007961force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007962 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007963 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7964 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7965
7966force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007967 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007968 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7969
7970force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007971 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007972 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7973
7974force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007975 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007976 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7977
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007978gid <gid>
7979 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7980 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7981 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7982 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7983 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7984
7985group <group>
7986 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7987 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7988 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7989 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7990 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7991
7992id <id>
7993 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7994 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7995 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7996 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7997
7998interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007999 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8000 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8001 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8002 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8003 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8004 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8005 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008006
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008007level <level>
8008 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8009 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8010 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8011 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8012 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8013 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8014 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8015 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8016 counters).
8017 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8018 all counters).
8019
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008020maxconn <maxconn>
8021 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8022 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8023 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8024 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8025 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8026 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8027 eat all memory.
8028
8029mode <mode>
8030 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8031 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8032 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8033 UNIX sockets.
8034
8035mss <maxseg>
8036 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8037 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8038 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8039 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8040 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8041 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8042 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8043 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8044 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8045 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8046 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8047
8048name <name>
8049 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8050 page.
8051
8052nice <nice>
8053 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8054 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8055 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8056 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8057 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8058 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8059 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8060 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8061 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8062 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8063 one for an RDP socket.
8064
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008065no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008066 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008067 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008068 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008069 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8070 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008071
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008072no-tls-tickets
8073 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8074 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8075 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8076 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8077
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008078no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008079 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008080 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008081 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8082 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8083 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008084
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008085no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008086 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008087 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008088 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8089 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8090 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008091
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008092no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008093 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008094 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008095 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8096 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8097 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008098
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008099npn <protocols>
8100 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8101 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8102 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8103 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008104 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8105 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008106
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008107ssl
8108 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008109 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008110 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8111 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8112 to deciphered contents.
8113
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008114strict-sni
8115 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8116 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8117 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8118 See the "crt" option for more information.
8119
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008120tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008121 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008122 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8123 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8124 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8125 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8126 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8127 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8128 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008129 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8130 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8131 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008132
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008133transparent
8134 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8135 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8136 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8137 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8138 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8139 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8140 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8141 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8142 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8143 so check for support with your vendor.
8144
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008145v4v6
8146 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8147 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8148 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8149 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008150 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008151
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008152v6only
8153 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8154 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8155 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008156 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8157 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008158
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008159uid <uid>
8160 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8161 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8162 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8163 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8164 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8165
8166user <user>
8167 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8168 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8169 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8170 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8171 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8172
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008173verify [none|optional|required]
8174 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8175 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8176 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8177 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8178 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008179 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8180 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8181 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8182 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008183
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020081845.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008185------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008186
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008187The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8188which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8189arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8190settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8191after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8192Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8193address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008195 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008196 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008197
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008198The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008199
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008200addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008201 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8202 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8203 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8204 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8205 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008207 Supported in default-server: No
8208
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008209agent-check
8210 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
8211 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
8212 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
8213 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
8214
8215 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
8216 e.g. "75%"
8217
8218 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8219 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8220
8221 * The string "drain".
8222
8223 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
8224 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
8225 persistence.
8226
8227 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
8228
8229 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
8230
8231 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
8232
8233 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8234
8235 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
8236
8237 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8238
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008239 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8240 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
8241 parameter.
8242
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008243 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
8244 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
8245
8246 Supported in default-server: No
8247
8248agent-inter <delay>
8249 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8250 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8251
8252 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8253 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8254 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8255 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8256 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8257 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8258 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8259 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8260 of backends use the same servers.
8261
8262 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8263
8264 Supported in default-server: Yes
8265
8266agent-port <port>
8267 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8268
8269 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8270
8271 Supported in default-server: Yes
8272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008273backup
8274 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8275 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8276 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8277 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8278 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8279 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008281 Supported in default-server: No
8282
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008283ca-file <cafile>
8284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8285 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8286 server's certificate.
8287
8288 Supported in default-server: No
8289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008290check
8291 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008292 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8293 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8294 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8295 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8296 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8297 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8298 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008299 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8300 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8301 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008303 Supported in default-server: No
8304
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008305check-send-proxy
8306 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8307 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8308 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8309 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8310 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8311 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8312 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8313
8314 Supported in default-server: No
8315
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008316check-ssl
8317 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8318 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8319 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8320 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008321 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008322 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8323 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8324 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8325 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8326
8327 Supported in default-server: No
8328
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008329ciphers <ciphers>
8330 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008331 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008332 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8333 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8334 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8335 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8336 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8337 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8338
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008339 Supported in default-server: No
8340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008341cookie <value>
8342 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8343 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8344 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8345 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8346 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8347 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8348 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8349
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008350 Supported in default-server: No
8351
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008352crl-file <crlfile>
8353 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8354 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8355 to verify server's certificate.
8356
8357 Supported in default-server: No
8358
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008359crt <cert>
8360 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8361 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8362 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8363 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8364 certificate request.
8365
8366 Supported in default-server: No
8367
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008368disabled
8369 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8370 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8371 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8372 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8373 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8374
8375 Supported in default-server: No
8376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008377error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008378 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8379 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8380 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008381
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008382 Supported in default-server: Yes
8383
8384 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008385
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008386fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008387 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8388 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8389 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8390
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008391 Supported in default-server: Yes
8392
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008393force-sslv3
8394 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8395 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8396 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8397
8398 Supported in default-server: No
8399
8400force-tlsv10
8401 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8402 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8403
8404 Supported in default-server: No
8405
8406force-tlsv11
8407 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8408 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8409
8410 Supported in default-server: No
8411
8412force-tlsv12
8413 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8414 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8415
8416 Supported in default-server: No
8417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008418id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008419 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8420 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8421 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008422
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008423 Supported in default-server: No
8424
8425inter <delay>
8426fastinter <delay>
8427downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008428 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8429 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8430 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8431 between checks depending on the server state :
8432
8433 Server state | Interval used
8434 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8435 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8436 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8437 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8438 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8439 or yet unchecked. |
8440 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8441 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8442 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008443
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008444 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8445 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8446 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8447 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008448 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8449 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8450 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8451 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8452 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008454 Supported in default-server: Yes
8455
8456maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008457 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8458 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8459 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8460 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8461 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8462 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8463 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8464 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8465
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008466 Supported in default-server: Yes
8467
8468maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008469 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8470 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8471 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8472 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8473 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8474 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8475 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8476
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008477 Supported in default-server: Yes
8478
8479minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008480 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8481 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8482 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8483 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8484 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8485 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008486 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008487 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008489 Supported in default-server: Yes
8490
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008491no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008492 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8493 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008494 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008495
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008496 Supported in default-server: No
8497
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008498no-tls-tickets
8499 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8500 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8501 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8502 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8503
8504 Supported in default-server: No
8505
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008506no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008507 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008508 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8509 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008510 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8511 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008512
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008513 Supported in default-server: No
8514
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008515no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008516 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008517 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8518 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008519 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8520 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008521
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008522 Supported in default-server: No
8523
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008524no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008525 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008526 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8527 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008528 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8529 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008530
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008531 Supported in default-server: No
8532
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008533non-stick
8534 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8535 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8536 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8537
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008538 Supported in default-server: No
8539
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008540observe <mode>
8541 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8542 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8543 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8544 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8545 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8546 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008547 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008549 Supported in default-server: No
8550
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008551 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8552
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008553on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008554 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8555 Currently, four modes are available:
8556 - fastinter: force fastinter
8557 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8558 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8559 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8560 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8561
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008562 Supported in default-server: Yes
8563
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008564 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8565
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008566on-marked-down <action>
8567 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8568 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008569 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8570 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8571 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8572 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8573 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8574 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8575 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8576 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008577
8578 Actions are disabled by default
8579
8580 Supported in default-server: Yes
8581
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008582on-marked-up <action>
8583 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8584 Currently one action is available:
8585 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8586 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8587 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8588 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8589 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8590 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8591 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8592 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8593
8594 Actions are disabled by default
8595
8596 Supported in default-server: Yes
8597
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008598port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008599 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8600 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8601 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8602 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8603 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8604 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8605
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008606 Supported in default-server: Yes
8607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008608redir <prefix>
8609 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8610 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8611 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8612 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8613 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8614 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8615 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8616 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008617 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008618 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8619 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8620 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8621 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8622 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8623
8624 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8625
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008626 Supported in default-server: No
8627
8628rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008629 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8630 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8631 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008633 Supported in default-server: Yes
8634
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008635send-proxy
8636 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8637 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8638 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8639 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8640 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8641 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8642 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8643 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8644 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008645 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8646 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8647 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8648 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8649 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008650
8651 Supported in default-server: No
8652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008653slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008654 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8655 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8656 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8657 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8658 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8659 parameters :
8660
8661 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8662 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8663
8664 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8665 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8666 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8667 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8668
8669 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8670 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8671 seen as failed.
8672
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008673 Supported in default-server: Yes
8674
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008675source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008676source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008677source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008678 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8679 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8680 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8681 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8682
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008683 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8684 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8685 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8686 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8687 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8688 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8689 server.
8690
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008691 Supported in default-server: No
8692
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008693ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008694 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8695 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8696 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8697 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8698 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8699 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008700 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008701
8702 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008704track [<proxy>/]<server>
8705 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8706 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8707 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8708 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8709 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8710
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008711 Supported in default-server: No
8712
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008713verify [none|required]
8714 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01008715 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
8716 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
8717 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
8718 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008719 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8720 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8721 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008722
8723 Supported in default-server: No
8724
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008725verifyhost <hostname>
8726 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8727 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8728 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8729 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8730 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8731 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8732
8733 Supported in default-server: No
8734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008735weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008736 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8737 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8738 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008739 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8740 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8741 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8742 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8743 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8744 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008746 Supported in default-server: Yes
8747
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008748
87496. HTTP header manipulation
8750---------------------------
8751
8752In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8753response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8754request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8755which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008756against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008757
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008758If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
8759to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
8760but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
8761HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
8762stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
8763because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
8764a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
8765still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008766
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008767This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8768in section 4.2 :
8769
8770 - reqadd <string>
8771 - reqallow <search>
8772 - reqiallow <search>
8773 - reqdel <search>
8774 - reqidel <search>
8775 - reqdeny <search>
8776 - reqideny <search>
8777 - reqpass <search>
8778 - reqipass <search>
8779 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8780 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8781 - reqtarpit <search>
8782 - reqitarpit <search>
8783 - rspadd <string>
8784 - rspdel <search>
8785 - rspidel <search>
8786 - rspdeny <search>
8787 - rspideny <search>
8788 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8789 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8790
8791With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8792is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8793parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8794prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8795Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8796
8797 \t for a tab
8798 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8799 \n for a new line (LF)
8800 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8801 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8802 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8803 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8804 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8805
8806The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8807portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8808above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8809regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
88109 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8811is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8812
8813The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8814after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8815
8816Notes related to these keywords :
8817---------------------------------
8818 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8819 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8820 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8821
8822 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8823 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8824 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8825
8826 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8827 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8828 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8829 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8830 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8831
8832 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8833 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8834 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8835 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8836 useless headers before adding new ones.
8837
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008838 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008839 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8840
8841 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8842 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8843 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8844
8845 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8846 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008847 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008848
8849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088507. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8851----------------------------------
8852
8853Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8854client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8855The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8856these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8857but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8858data called patterns.
8859
8860
88617.1. ACL basics
8862---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008863
8864The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8865content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8866from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8867simple :
8868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008869 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008870 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008871 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8872 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008874The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8875adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008876
8877In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008879 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008880
8881This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8882Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8883and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008884an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
8885conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
8886as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
8887are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008888
8889ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8890'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8891which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8892
8893There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8894performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008896The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8897specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8898this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008899methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
8900ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008901
8902Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8903 - boolean
8904 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8905 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8906 - string
8907 - data block
8908
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008909Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
8910converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
8911would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
8912The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
8913which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
8914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008915The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8916 - boolean
8917 - integer or integer range
8918 - IP address / network
8919 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8920 - regular expression
8921 - hex block
8922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008923The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8924
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008925 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8926 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008927 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01008928 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01008929 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01008930 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008931 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008933The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8934read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8935if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8936lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8937will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8938beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8939a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8940lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8941exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8942
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01008943The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
8944parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
8945ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
8946a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
8947check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
8948
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01008949The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
8950socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
8951file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
8952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008953Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8954loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8955
8956 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8957
8958In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8959the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8960case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8961as well.
8962
8963The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8964sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8965do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8966methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8967is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8968obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8969followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8970default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8971that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8972string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8973
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01008974The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
8975By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
8976string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
8977resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
8978server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
8979waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
8980flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
8981function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
8982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008983There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8984sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8985be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008986
8987 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
8988 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008989 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
8990 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
8991 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
8992 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008993
8994 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
8995 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008996 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008997
8998 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008999 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009000
9001 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009002 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009003
9004 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9005 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9006
9007 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9008 binary or string samples.
9009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009010 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9011 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009013 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9014 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9015 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009017 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9018 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009020 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9021 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009023 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9024 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009026 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9027 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009028 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009030 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9031 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9032 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009033
9034For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9035request, it is possible to do :
9036
9037 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9038
9039In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9040buffer, one would use the following acl :
9041
9042 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9043
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009044On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9045possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9046
9047 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009049All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9050criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9051method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9052to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9053criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9054the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009056If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009057the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9058For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009060 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9061 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9062 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9063 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009064
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009065
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009066The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009067and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9068combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
9069the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009071 +-------------------------------------------------+
9072 | Input sample type |
9073 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9074 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
9075 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9076 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9077 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009078 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009079 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009080 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009081 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009082 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009083 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009084 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009085 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009086 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009087 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009088 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009089 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009090 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009091 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009092 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009093 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009094 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009095 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009096 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009097 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009098 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009099 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9100 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9101 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009102
9103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091047.1.1. Matching booleans
9105------------------------
9106
9107In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9108Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9109When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9110that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9111
9112Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9113return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9114"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9115
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091177.1.2. Matching integers
9118------------------------
9119
9120Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9121enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9122to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9123
9124Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9125matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9126lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009127
9128For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9129unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9130representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9131
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009132As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9133two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9134instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9135ranges and operators.
9136
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009137For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009138operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9139Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9140of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009141
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009142Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009143
9144 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9145 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9146 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9147 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9148 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9149
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009150For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009151
9152 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9153
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009154This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9155
9156 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9157
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091597.1.3. Matching strings
9160-----------------------
9161
9162String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9163different forms :
9164
9165 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9166 patterns ;
9167
9168 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9169 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9170
9171 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9172 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9173
9174 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9175 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9176
9177 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9178 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9179 matches.
9180
9181 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9182 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9183 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009184
9185String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9186exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9187characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9188string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9189to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009190before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009191
9192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091937.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9194---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009195
9196Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9197they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9198possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9199passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9200the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009201the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9202match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009203
9204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092057.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9206-------------------------------------
9207
9208It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9209not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9210a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9211to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9212digits may be used upper or lower case.
9213
9214Example :
9215 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9216 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9217
9218
92197.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9220---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009221
9222IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9223netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9224within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009225host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009226difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9227at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9228does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9229parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009230
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009231IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9232Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9233trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9234IPv6 patterns.
9235
9236HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9237following situations :
9238 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9239 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9240 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9241 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9242 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9243 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9244 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9245 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9246 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9247 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009249
92507.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9251----------------------------------
9252
9253Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9254combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9255
9256 - AND (implicit)
9257 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9258 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009260A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009262 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009264Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9265indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009267For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9268"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9269requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9270is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9271
9272 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9273 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9274 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9275 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9276
9277To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9278and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9279
9280 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9281 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9282 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9283 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9284
9285 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9286 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9287 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9288 use_backend www if host_www
9289
9290It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9291expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9292be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9293the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9294
9295 The following rule :
9296
9297 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9298 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9299
9300 Can also be written that way :
9301
9302 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9303
9304It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9305to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9306simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9307sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9308good use is the following :
9309
9310 With named ACLs :
9311
9312 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9313 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9314 monitor fail if site_dead
9315
9316 With anonymous ACLs :
9317
9318 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9319
9320See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9321
9322
93237.3. Fetching samples
9324---------------------
9325
9326Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9327against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9328sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9329ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9330of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9331available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9332
9333This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9334Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9335compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9336deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9337
9338The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9339matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9340method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9341indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9342
9343As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9344when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9345mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9346the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9347ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9348
9349Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9350multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9351when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9352incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9353are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9354is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9355all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9356
9357Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9358 - name
9359 - name(arg1)
9360 - name(arg1,arg2)
9361
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009362Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9363of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9364is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9365was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9366has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9367unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9368
9369These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9370sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9371the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9372support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009374The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009376 lower Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed
9377 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9378 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009380 upper Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed
9381 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9382 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009383
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009384 hex Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two
9385 hex digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex
9386 dumps of some binary input data in a way that can be reliably
9387 transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009389 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for
9390 lookups and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within
9391 a certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9392 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9393 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9394
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009395 http_date([<offset>])
9396 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to
9397 a string representing this date in a format suitable for use
9398 in HTTP header fields. If an offset value is specified, then
9399 it is a number of seconds that is added to the date before the
9400 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit
9401 Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined
9402 with a positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the
9403 offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009404
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009405 language(<value[;value[;value[;...]]]>[,<default>])
9406 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as
9407 extracted from the "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr".
9408 Values with no q-factor have a q-factor of 1. Values with a
9409 q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which belong to the
9410 list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. If
9411 no value matches the given list and a default value is
9412 provided, it is returned. Note that language names may have
9413 a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in
9414 the list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base
9415 language is checked. The match is case-sensitive, and the
9416 output string is always one of those provided in arguments.
9417 The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the ordering
9418 of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9419 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
9420
9421 Example :
9422
Thierry FOURNIER45ad91e2014-04-16 11:10:53 +02009423 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9424 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009425
Thierry FOURNIER45ad91e2014-04-16 11:10:53 +02009426 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9427 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9428 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9429 use_backend spanish if es
9430 use_backend french if fr
9431 use_backend english if en
9432 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009433
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009434 map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9435 map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9436 map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9437 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type>
9438 matching method, and return the associated value converted to
9439 the type <output_type>. If the input value cannot be found in
9440 the <map_file>, the converter returns the <default_value>. If
9441 the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and acts
9442 as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is
9443 not set, it defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type>
9444 is not set, it defaults to "str". For convenience, the "map"
9445 keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a string to another
9446 string. The following array contains contains the list of all
9447 the map* converters.
9448
9449 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP
9450 addresses and strings are stored in trees, so the first of the
9451 finest match will be used. Other keys are stored in lists, so
9452 the first matching occurrence will be used.
9453
9454 +----+----------+---------+-------------+------------+
9455 | `-_ out | | | |
9456 | input `-_ | str | int | ip |
9457 | / match `-_ | | | |
9458 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9459 | str / str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip |
9460 | str / sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip |
9461 | str / dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip |
9462 | str / dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip |
9463 | str / end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip |
9464 | str / reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip |
9465 | int / int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip |
9466 | ip / ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip |
9467 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9468
9469 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start
9470 with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and
9471 spaces are stripped. The key is then the first "word" (series
9472 of non-space/tabs characters), and the value is what follows
9473 this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9474 trailing spaces/tabs.
9475
9476 Example :
9477
9478 # this is a comment and is ignored
9479 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9480 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9481 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9482 | | | `----------- value
9483 | | `--------------------- middle spaces ignored
9484 | `---------------------------- key
9485 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094877.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
9488--------------------------------------------
9489
9490A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9491not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9492"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9493The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9494
9495always_false : boolean
9496 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9497 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9498
9499always_true : boolean
9500 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9501 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9502
9503avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009504 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009505 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9506 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9507 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9508 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9509 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9510 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9511 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9512 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9513 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9514 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9515 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9516 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9517 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009519be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009520 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9521 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9522 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9523 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9524 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009526be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9527 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9528 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9529 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9530 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9531 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9532 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009533
9534 Example :
9535 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9536 backend dynamic
9537 mode http
9538 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9539 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009541connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9542 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009543 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009544 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9545 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009546
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009547 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009548 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009549 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9550
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009551 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9552 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009553
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009554 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009555 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009556 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009557 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9558 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009559 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009560 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009561
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009562 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9563 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009564 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009565 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009566
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009567date([<offset>]) : integer
9568 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9569 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9570 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9571 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009572 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9573
9574 Example :
9575
9576 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9577 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009578
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009579env(<name>) : string
9580 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9581 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9582 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9583 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9584 certain way.
9585
9586 Examples :
9587 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9588 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9589
9590 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9591 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009593fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9594 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009595 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9596 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009597 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9598 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9599 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9600 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9601 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009603fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9604 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9605 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9606 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9607 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9608 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9609 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9610 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9611 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009612
9613 Example :
9614 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9615 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9616 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9617 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9618 frontend mail
9619 bind :25
9620 mode tcp
9621 maxconn 100
9622 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9623 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9624 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9625 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009627nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9628 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9629 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9630 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009631 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9632 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9633 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009635queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009636 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9637 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9638 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009639 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9640 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9641 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9642 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9643 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9644
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +01009645rand([<range>]) : integer
9646 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
9647 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
9648 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
9649 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
9650 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
9651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009652srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9653 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9654 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9655 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9656 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9657 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9658 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9659 methods.
9660
9661srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9662 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9663 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9664 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9665 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9666 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9667 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9668 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9669
9670srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9671 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9672 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009673 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009674 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9675 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9676 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9677 overloading servers).
9678
9679 Example :
9680 # Redirect to a separate back
9681 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9682 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9683 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9684
9685table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9686 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9687 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9688
9689table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9690 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9691 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9692 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9693
9694
96957.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
9696----------------------------------
9697
9698The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9699closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9700methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9701sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9702TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009703the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9704counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9705"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009706argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9707the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9708this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009709
9710be_id : integer
9711 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9712 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9713
9714dst : ip
9715 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9716 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9717 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9718 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9719 RFC 4291.
9720
9721dst_conn : integer
9722 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9723 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9724 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9725 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9726 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9727 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9728 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9729 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009731dst_port : integer
9732 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9733 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9734 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9735 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9736 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9737 an HTTP header.
9738
9739fe_id : integer
9740 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9741 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9742 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9743
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009744sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9745sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9746sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9747sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009748 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9749 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9750 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9751
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009752sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9753sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9754sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9755sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009756 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9757 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9758 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9759
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009760sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9761sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9762sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9763sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009764 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9765 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009766 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9767 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9768 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009769
9770 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9771 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009772 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9773 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9774 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009775 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9776 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9777
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009778sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9779sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9780sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9781sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009782 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9783 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9784
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009785sc_conn_cur(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9786sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9787sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9788sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009789 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9790 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9791 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9792
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009793sc_conn_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9794sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9795sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9796sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009797 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9798 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9799 See also src_conn_rate.
9800
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009801sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9802sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9803sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9804sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009805 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009806 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009807
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009808sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9809sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9810sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9811sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009812 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9813 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9814 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009815 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9816 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9817 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009818
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009819sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9820sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9821sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9822sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009823 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9824 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9825 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9826
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009827sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9828sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9829sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9830sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009831 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9832 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9833 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9834 src_http_err_rate.
9835
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009836sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9837sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9838sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9839sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009840 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9841 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9842 src_http_req_cnt.
9843
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009844sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9845sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9846sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9847sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009848 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9849 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9850 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9851 src_http_req_rate.
9852
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009853sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9854sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9855sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9856sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009857 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009858 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9859 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9860 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9861 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009862
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009863 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9864 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009865 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9866
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009867sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9868sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9869sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9870sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009871 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9872 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9873 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9874 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9875
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009876sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9877sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9878sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9879sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009880 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9881 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9882 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9883 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9884
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009885sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9886sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9887sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9888sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009889 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9890 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9891 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9892 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009893 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009894 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9895
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009896sc_sess_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9897sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9898sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9899sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009900 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9901 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9902 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9903 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9904 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009905 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009906
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009907sc_tracked(<ctr>,[<table>]) : boolean
9908sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9909sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9910sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009911 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9912 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9913 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9914
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009915sc_trackers(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9916sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9917sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9918sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009919 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9920 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009921 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009922 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9923 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009924 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9925 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9926 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009928so_id : integer
9929 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9930 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9931 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009933src : ip
9934 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9935 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9936 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9937 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9938 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9939 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9940 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009941
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009942 Example:
9943 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
9944 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
9945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009946src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9947 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9948 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9949 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009950 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009952src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9953 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9954 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009955 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009956 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009958src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9959 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9960 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9961 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9962 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9963 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9964 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009965
9966 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9967 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9968 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9969 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009970 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009971 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9972 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009974src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009975 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009976 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009977 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009978 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009980src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009981 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009982 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9983 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009984 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009986src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9987 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
9988 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9989 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009990 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009992src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009993 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009994 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009995 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009996 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009998src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009999 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010000 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010001 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10002 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010003 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10004 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10005 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010007src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10008 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10009 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010010 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010011 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010012 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010014src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10015 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10016 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10017 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10018 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010019 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010021src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10022 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10023 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10024 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010025 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010027src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10028 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10029 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10030 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010031 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010032 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010034src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10035 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10036 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10037 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010038 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010039 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10040 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010041
10042 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010043 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010044 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010046src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10047 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10048 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10049 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10050 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010051 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10052 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010054src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10055 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10056 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010057 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10058 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010059 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010061src_port : integer
10062 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10063 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10064 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10065 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010067src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10068 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010069 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10070 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10071 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010072 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010074src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10075 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10076 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10077 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10078 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010079 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010081src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10082 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10083 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10084 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10085 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10086 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10087 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10088 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10089 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010090
10091 Example :
10092 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10093 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10094 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10095 listen ssh
10096 bind :22
10097 mode tcp
10098 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010099 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010100 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010101 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010103srv_id : integer
10104 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10105 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10106 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010107
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101097.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
10110----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010112The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10113closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10114when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10115usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010116future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010118ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10119 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10120 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10121 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10122 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10123 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010125ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10126 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10127 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10128 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10129 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010131ssl_c_err : integer
10132 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10133 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10134 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10135 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10136 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010138ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10139 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10140 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10141 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10142 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10143 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10144 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10145 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10146 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010148 ACL derivatives :
10149 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010151ssl_c_key_alg : string
10152 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10153 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10154 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010156 ACL derivatives :
10157 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010159ssl_c_notafter : string
10160 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10161 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10162 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010164 ACL derivatives :
10165 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010167ssl_c_notbefore : string
10168 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10169 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10170 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010172 ACL derivatives :
10173 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010175ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10176 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10177 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10178 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10179 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10180 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10181 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10182 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10183 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010185 ACL derivatives :
10186 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010188ssl_c_serial : binary
10189 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10190 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10191 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010193 ACL derivatives :
10194 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010196ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10197 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10198 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10199 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010201ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10202 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10203 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10204 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010206 ACL derivatives :
10207 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
10208
10209ssl_c_used : boolean
10210 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10211 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010213ssl_c_verify : integer
10214 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10215 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10216 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10217 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010219ssl_c_version : integer
10220 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10221 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010223ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10224 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10225 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10226 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10227 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010228 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010229 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10230 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10231 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010233 ACL derivatives :
10234 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010236ssl_f_key_alg : string
10237 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10238 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10239 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010241 ACL derivatives :
10242 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010244ssl_f_notafter : string
10245 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10246 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10247 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010249 ACL derivatives :
10250 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010252ssl_f_notbefore : string
10253 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10254 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10255 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010257 ACL derivatives :
10258 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010260ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10261 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10262 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10263 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10264 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10265 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10266 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10267 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10268 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010270 ACL derivatives :
10271 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010273ssl_f_serial : binary
10274 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10275 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10276 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010278 ACL derivatives :
10279 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010281ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10282 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10283 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10284 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010286 ACL derivatives :
10287 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010289ssl_f_version : integer
10290 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10291 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10292
10293ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010294 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10295 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10296 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010298 Example :
10299 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10300 listen http-https
10301 bind :80
10302 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10303 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10304
10305ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10306 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10307 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10308
10309ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010310 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010311 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10312 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10313 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10314 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10315 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10316 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10317 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10318 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10319
10320 ACL derivatives :
10321 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010323ssl_fc_cipher : string
10324 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10325 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010327 ACL derivatives :
10328 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010330ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010331 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10332 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010333 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10334 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10335 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10336 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010338ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10339 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010340 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10341 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10342 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10343 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010345ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010346 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010347 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10348 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10349 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10350 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10351 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10352 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10353 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010355 ACL derivatives :
10356 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010358ssl_fc_protocol : string
10359 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10360 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010362 ACL derivatives :
10363 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
10364
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010365ssl_fc_unique_id : string
10366 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10367 returns a base64 encoded string containing the TLS unique ID as defined
10368 in RFC5929 section 3.
10369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010370ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10371 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10372 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10373 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10374 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010376ssl_fc_sni : string
10377 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10378 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10379 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10380 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10381 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10382
10383 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10384 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10385 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010386 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10387 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010389 ACL derivatives :
10390 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
10391 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10392 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010394ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10395 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10396 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010397
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200103997.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
10400------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010402Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10403sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10404only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10405For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10406be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10407can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10408sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10409for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10410content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010412payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10413 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10414 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10415 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010417payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10418 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10419 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10420 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010422req.len : integer
10423req_len : integer (deprecated)
10424 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10425 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10426 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10427 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10428 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10429 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10430 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10431 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010433req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10434 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010435 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10436 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10437 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10438 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010440 ACL alternatives :
10441 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010443req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10444 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10445 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10446 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10447 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010449 ACL alternatives :
10450 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010452 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010454req.proto_http : boolean
10455req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10456 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10457 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10458 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10459 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10460 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10461 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10462 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010464 Example:
10465 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10466 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10467 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010468 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010470req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10471rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10472 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10473 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10474 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10475 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10476 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10477 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10478 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010480 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10481 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10482 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10483 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10484 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10485 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010487 ACL derivatives :
10488 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010490 Example :
10491 listen tse-farm
10492 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10493 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10494 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10495 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10496 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10497 persist rdp-cookie
10498 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10499 # This is only useful makes sense if
10500 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10501 stick-table type string size 204800
10502 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10503 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10504 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010506 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10507 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010509req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10510rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10511 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10512 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10513 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10514 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010516 ACL derivatives :
10517 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010519req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10520req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10521 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10522 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10523 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10524 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10525 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10526 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10527 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010529req.ssl_sni : string
10530req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10531 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10532 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10533 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10534 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10535 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10536 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10537 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10538 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10539 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10540 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10541 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10542 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010544 ACL derivatives :
10545 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010547 Examples :
10548 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10549 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10550 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10551 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10552 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010554res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10555rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10556 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10557 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10558 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10559 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10560 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10561 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10562 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010564req.ssl_ver : integer
10565req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10566 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10567 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10568 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10569 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10570 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10571 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10572 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10573 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10574 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010576 ACL derivatives :
10577 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010578
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010579res.len : integer
10580 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10581 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10582 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10583 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10584 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10585 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10586 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10587 content inspection.
10588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010589res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10590 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010591 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10592 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10593 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10594 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010596res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10597 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10598 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10599 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10600 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010602 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010604wait_end : boolean
10605 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10606 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10607 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10608 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10609 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10610 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10611 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10612 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010614 Examples :
10615 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10616 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10617 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010619 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10620 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10621 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10622 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10623 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10624 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10625 tcp-request content reject
10626
10627
106287.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
10629--------------------------------------
10630
10631It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10632This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10633data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10634its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10635HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10636content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10637to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10638more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10639response are indexed.
10640
10641base : string
10642 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10643 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10644 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10645 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10646 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10647 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10648 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10649 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10650
10651 ACL derivatives :
10652 base : exact string match
10653 base_beg : prefix match
10654 base_dir : subdir match
10655 base_dom : domain match
10656 base_end : suffix match
10657 base_len : length match
10658 base_reg : regex match
10659 base_sub : substring match
10660
10661base32 : integer
10662 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10663 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10664 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10665 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10666
10667base32+src : binary
10668 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10669 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10670 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10671 per-URL counters.
10672
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010010673capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
10674 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
10675 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10676 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
10677
10678capture.req.method : string
10679 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
10680 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
10681 because it's allocated.
10682
10683capture.req.uri : string
10684 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
10685 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
10686 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
10687 allocated.
10688
10689capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
10690 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
10691 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10692 The first entry is an index of 0.
10693 See also: "capture response header"
10694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010695req.cook([<name>]) : string
10696cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10697 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10698 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10699 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10700 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10701 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10702 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10703 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10704 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10705
10706 ACL derivatives :
10707 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10708 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10709 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10710 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10711 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10712 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10713 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10714 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010716req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10717cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10718 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10719 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010721req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10722cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10723 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10724 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10725 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10726 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010728cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10729 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10730 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10731 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10732 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10733 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10734 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10735 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10736 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10737 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10738 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010740hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10741 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10742 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10743 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10744 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010745 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010747req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10748 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10749 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10750 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10751 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10752 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10753 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10754 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10755 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010757req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10758 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10759 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10760 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10761 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010763req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10764 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10765 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10766 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10767 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10768 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10769 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10770 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10771 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10772 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10773 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10774 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010776 ACL derivatives :
10777 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10778 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10779 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10780 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10781 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10782 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10783 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10784 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10785
10786req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10787hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10788 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10789 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10790 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10791 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10792 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10793 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10794 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10795 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10796 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10797
10798req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10799hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10800 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10801 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10802 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10803 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10804 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10805 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10806 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10807 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10808
10809req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10810hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10811 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10812 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10813 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10814 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10815 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10816 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10817 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10818
10819http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10820 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10821 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10822 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10823 basic auth is supported.
10824
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010010825http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
10826 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
10827 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
10828 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
10829 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010830 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10831 basic auth is supported.
10832
10833 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010010834 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
10835 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
10836 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
10837 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010838
10839http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010840 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10841 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010842 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10843 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010845method : integer + string
10846 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10847 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10848 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10849 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10850 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10851 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10852 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010854 ACL derivatives :
10855 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010857 Example :
10858 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10859 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10860 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010862path : string
10863 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10864 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10865 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10866 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10867 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10868 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10869 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010871 ACL derivatives :
10872 path : exact string match
10873 path_beg : prefix match
10874 path_dir : subdir match
10875 path_dom : domain match
10876 path_end : suffix match
10877 path_len : length match
10878 path_reg : regex match
10879 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010881req.ver : string
10882req_ver : string (deprecated)
10883 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10884 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10885 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010887 ACL derivatives :
10888 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010890res.comp : boolean
10891 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10892 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10893 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010895res.comp_algo : string
10896 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10897 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10898 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010900res.cook([<name>]) : string
10901scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10902 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10903 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10904 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010906 ACL derivatives :
10907 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010909res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10910scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10911 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10912 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10913 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010915res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10916scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10917 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10918 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10919 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010921res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10922 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10923 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10924 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10925 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10926 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10927 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10928 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10929 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10930 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010932res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10933 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10934 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10935 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10936 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10937 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010939res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10940shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10941 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10942 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10943 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10944 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10945 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10946 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10947 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10948 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010950 ACL derivatives :
10951 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10952 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10953 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10954 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10955 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10956 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10957 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10958 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10959
10960res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10961shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10962 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10963 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10964 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10965 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10966 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010968res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10969shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10970 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10971 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10972 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10973 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10974 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10975 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010977res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10978shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10979 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10980 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10981 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10982 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10983 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10984 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010986res.ver : string
10987resp_ver : string (deprecated)
10988 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
10989 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010991 ACL derivatives :
10992 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010994set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10995 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10996 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
10997 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
10998 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011000 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11001 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011003 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011005status : integer
11006 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11007 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11008 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011010url : string
11011 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11012 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11013 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11014 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11015 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11016 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11017 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011019 ACL derivatives :
11020 url : exact string match
11021 url_beg : prefix match
11022 url_dir : subdir match
11023 url_dom : domain match
11024 url_end : suffix match
11025 url_len : length match
11026 url_reg : regex match
11027 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011029url_ip : ip
11030 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11031 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11032 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11033 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11034 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11035 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11036 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011038url_port : integer
11039 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11040 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11041 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11042 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011044urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11045url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11046 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11047 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11048 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11049 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11050 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11051 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11052 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11053 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11054 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011056 ACL derivatives :
11057 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11058 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11059 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11060 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11061 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11062 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11063 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11064 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011065
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011067 Example :
11068 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11069 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11070 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11071 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011073urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11074 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11075 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11076 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011077
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200110797.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011080---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011081
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011082Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11083every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011084order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011086ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11087---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011088FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011089HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011090HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11091HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011092HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11093HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11094HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11095HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11096LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011097METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11098METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11099METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11100METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11101METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11102METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011103RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011104REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011105TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011106WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11107---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011108
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111108. Logging
11111----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011112
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011113One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11114provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11115very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11116provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11117state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011118to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011119headers.
11120
11121In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11122about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11123send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11124
11125 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11126 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11127 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11128 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11129 at the termination.
11130
11131The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11132allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11133as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11134while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11135real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11136delay.
11137
11138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111398.1. Log levels
11140---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011141
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011142TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011143source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011144HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11145in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11146track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11147syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11148about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011149
11150
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111518.2. Log formats
11152----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011153
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011154HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011155and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11156slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11157options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011158
11159 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11160 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11161 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11162 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11163 extents.
11164
11165 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11166 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11167 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11168 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11169 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11170
11171 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11172 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11173 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11174 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11175 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11176
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011177 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11178 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11179 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11180 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11181
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011182 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11183
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011184Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11185specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11186field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11187servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11188always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11189identifier.
11190
11191Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11192 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11193 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11194 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11195 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11196
11197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111988.2.1. Default log format
11199-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011200
11201This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11202as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11203format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11204
11205 Example :
11206 listen www
11207 mode http
11208 log global
11209 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11210
11211 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11212 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11213 (www/HTTP)
11214
11215 Field Format Extract from the example above
11216 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11217 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11218 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11219 4 'to' to
11220 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11221 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11222
11223Detailed fields description :
11224 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11225 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11226 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11227 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11228 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11229 and processed the connection.
11230 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11231
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011232In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11233"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11234connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11235
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011236It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11237will eventually disappear.
11238
11239
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112408.2.2. TCP log format
11241---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011242
11243The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11244is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11245information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11246counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11247emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11248environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11249the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11250sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011251specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11252not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11253fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11254marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011255
11256 Example :
11257 frontend fnt
11258 mode tcp
11259 option tcplog
11260 log global
11261 default_backend bck
11262
11263 backend bck
11264 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11265
11266 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11267 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11268 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11269
11270 Field Format Extract from the example above
11271 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11272 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11273 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11274 4 frontend_name fnt
11275 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11276 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11277 7 bytes_read* 212
11278 8 termination_state --
11279 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11280 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11281
11282Detailed fields description :
11283 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011284 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11285 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11286 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11287 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11288 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011289
11290 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011291 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11292 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11293 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011294
11295 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11296 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11297 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11298 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11299
11300 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11301 and processed the connection.
11302
11303 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11304 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11305 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11306 applications.
11307
11308 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11309 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11310 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11311 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11312 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11313
11314 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11315 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11316 See "Timers" below for more details.
11317
11318 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11319 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11320 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11321 "Timers" below for more details.
11322
11323 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011324 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011325 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11326 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11327 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11328 details.
11329
11330 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11331 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11332 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11333 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11334 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11335
11336 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11337 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11338 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11339 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11340 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11341 for more details.
11342
11343 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011344 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011345 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11346 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11347 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011348 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011349
11350 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11351 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11352 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11353 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11354 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11355 caused by a denial of service attack.
11356
11357 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11358 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11359 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11360 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11361 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11362 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11363 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11364 denial of service attack.
11365
11366 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11367 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11368 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11369 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11370 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11371 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11372 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11373 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11374 be processed than on other servers.
11375
11376 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11377 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11378 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11379 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11380 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11381 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11382 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11383 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11384 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11385 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11386 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11387 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11388 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11389
11390 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11391 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11392 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11393 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11394 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11395 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11396 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11397 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11398
11399 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11400 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11401 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11402 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11403 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11404 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11405 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11406 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11407 occurs.
11408
11409
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114108.2.3. HTTP log format
11411----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011412
11413The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11414is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11415the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11416are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11417emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11418generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11419"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11420which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011421frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11422is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011423
11424Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11425slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11426with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11427
11428 Example :
11429 frontend http-in
11430 mode http
11431 option httplog
11432 log global
11433 default_backend bck
11434
11435 backend static
11436 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11437
11438 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11439 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11440 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011441 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011442
11443 Field Format Extract from the example above
11444 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11445 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11446 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11447 4 frontend_name http-in
11448 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11449 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11450 7 status_code 200
11451 8 bytes_read* 2750
11452 9 captured_request_cookie -
11453 10 captured_response_cookie -
11454 11 termination_state ----
11455 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11456 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11457 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11458 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11459 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011460
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011461
11462Detailed fields description :
11463 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011464 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11465 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11466 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11467 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11468 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011469
11470 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011471 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11472 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11473 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011474
11475 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11476 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11477 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11478 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11479 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11480
11481 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11482 and processed the connection.
11483
11484 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11485 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11486 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11487
11488 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11489 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11490 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11491 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11492 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11493 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11494
11495 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11496 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11497 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11498 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11499 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11500 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11501
11502 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11503 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11504 See "Timers" below for more details.
11505
11506 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11507 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11508 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11509 below for more details.
11510
11511 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11512 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11513 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11514 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11515 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11516 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11517 for more details.
11518
11519 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011520 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011521 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11522 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11523 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11524 details.
11525
11526 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11527 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11528 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11529
11530 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11531 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11532 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11533 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11534 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11535 overflowing.
11536
11537 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11538 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11539 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11540 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11541 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11542 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11543 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11544 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11545
11546 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11547 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11548 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11549 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11550 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11551 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11552 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11553 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11554
11555 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11556 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11557 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11558 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11559 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11560 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11561 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11562
11563 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011564 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011565 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11566 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11567 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011568 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011569 system.
11570
11571 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11572 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11573 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11574 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11575 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11576 caused by a denial of service attack.
11577
11578 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11579 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11580 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11581 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11582 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11583 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11584 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11585 denial of service attack.
11586
11587 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11588 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11589 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11590 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11591 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11592 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11593 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11594 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11595 processed than on other servers.
11596
11597 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11598 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11599 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11600 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11601 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11602 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11603 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11604 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11605 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11606 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11607 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11608 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11609 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11610
11611 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11612 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11613 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11614 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11615 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11616 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11617 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11618 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11619
11620 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11621 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11622 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11623 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11624 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11625 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11626 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11627 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11628 occurs.
11629
11630 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11631 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11632 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11633 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11634 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11635 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11636 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11637 cookies" below for more details.
11638
11639 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11640 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11641 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11642 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11643 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11644 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11645 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11646 and cookies" below for more details.
11647
11648 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11649 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11650 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11651 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11652 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11653 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11654 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11655 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11656
11657
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200116588.2.4. Custom log format
11659------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011660
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011661The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011662mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011663
11664HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11665Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11666separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11667prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11668
11669Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11670variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11671string formats ("Q").
11672
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011673If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011674as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011675less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11676the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11677
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011678Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011679In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011680in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011681
11682Flags are :
11683 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011684 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011685
11686 Example:
11687
11688 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11689 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11690
11691At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11692
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011693 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11694 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011695
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011696the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011697
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011698 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011699 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011700 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011701
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011702and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11703
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011704 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011705 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11706
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011707Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11708
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011709 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011710 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011711 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11712 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11713 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011714 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11715 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11716 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011717 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011718 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011719 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011720 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011721 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011722 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011723 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11724 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011725 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011726 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11727 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011728 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011729 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11730 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011731 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11732 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11733 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011734 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011735 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11736 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011737 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011738 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11739 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11740 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011741 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011742 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11743 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11744 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11745 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011746 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011747 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011748 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011749 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010011750 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011751 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011752 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11753 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11754 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011755 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011756 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11757 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011758 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011759 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011760 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011761 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011762
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011763 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011764
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011765
117668.2.5. Error log format
11767-----------------------
11768
11769When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11770protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11771By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11772"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11773will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11774logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11775
11776The format looks like this :
11777
11778 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11779 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11780 Connection error during SSL handshake
11781
11782 Field Format Extract from the example above
11783 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11784 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11785 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11786 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11787 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11788
11789These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11790failures.
11791
11792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117938.3. Advanced logging options
11794-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011795
11796Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11797just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11798options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11799for more information about their usage.
11800
11801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11803------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011804
11805It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11806haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11807commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11808monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11809ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11810
11811 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11812 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11813 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11814 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11815
11816 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11817 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11818 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011819 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011820 such as other load-balancers.
11821
11822 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11823 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11824 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11825
11826
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118278.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11828----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011829
11830The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11831what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11832or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11833"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11834just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11835log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11836after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11837is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11838with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11839with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11840
11841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118428.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11843------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011844
11845Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11846for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11847"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11848retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11849raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11850a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11851file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11852you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11853"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11854
11855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118568.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11857--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011858
11859Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11860multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11861them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11862"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11863logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11864error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11865and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11866too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11867useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11868alternative.
11869
11870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118718.4. Timing events
11872------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011873
11874Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11875reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11876the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11877frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11878mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11879
11880 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11881 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11882 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11883 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11884 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11885
11886 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11887 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11888 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11889 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11890 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11891
11892 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11893 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11894 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11895 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11896 connection never established.
11897
11898 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11899 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11900 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11901 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11902 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11903 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11904 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11905 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11906 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11907 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11908 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11909
11910 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11911 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11912 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11913 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011914 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011915
11916 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11917
11918 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11919 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11920 negative.
11921
11922These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11923protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11924that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011925due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011926close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11927session has been aborted on timeout.
11928
11929Most common cases :
11930
11931 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11932 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11933 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11934 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11935 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11936 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11937 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11938 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11939 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011940 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11941 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11942 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011943
11944 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11945 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11946 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11947 of ms on remote networks.
11948
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011949 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11950 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11951 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011952
11953 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11954 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11955 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11956 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11957 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11958 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11959 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11960 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11961 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11962 to the server until another one is released.
11963
11964Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11965
11966 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11967 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11968 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11969
11970 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11971 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11972 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11973
11974 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11975 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11976 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11977 flags.
11978
11979 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11980 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11981 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11982 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11983 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11984 the client connection was maintained open.
11985
11986 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011987 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011988 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
11989 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
11990
11991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119928.5. Session state at disconnection
11993-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011994
11995TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
11996"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
119972-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
11998each of which has a special meaning :
11999
12000 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12001 session to terminate :
12002
12003 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12004
12005 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12006 server explicitly refused it.
12007
12008 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12009 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12010 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12011 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012012 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12013
12014 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12015 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012016
12017 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12018 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12019 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12020 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12021 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12022
12023 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12024 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12025 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12026 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12027 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12028
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012029 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12030 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12031
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012032 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12033 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12034 backup connections when going up.
12035
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012036 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12037
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012038 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12039 send or receive data.
12040
12041 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12042 send or receive data.
12043
12044 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12045 with nothing left in the buffers.
12046
12047 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12048
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012049 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012050 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12051
12052 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12053 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12054 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12055 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12056 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12057
12058 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12059 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12060
12061 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12062 server (HTTP only).
12063
12064 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12065
12066 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12067 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12068 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12069
12070 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12071 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12072 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12073
12074 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12075
12076 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12077 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12078
12079 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12080 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12081 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12082
12083 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12084 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012085 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12086 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012087
12088 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12089 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12090 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12091 another server.
12092
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012093 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012094 server.
12095
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012096 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12097 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12098 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12099 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12100
12101 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12102 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12103 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12104 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12105
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012106 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12107 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12108 "use-server" rule).
12109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012110 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12111
12112 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12113 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12114
12115 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12116
12117 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12118 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12119 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12120
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012121 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12122 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012123 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012124 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12125 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12126
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012127 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12128
12129 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12130 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12131
12132 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12133
12134 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12135
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012136The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12137was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012138helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12139starvation, attacks, etc...
12140
12141The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12142alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12143easier finding and understanding.
12144
12145 Flags Reason
12146
12147 -- Normal termination.
12148
12149 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12150 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12151 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12152 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12153
12154 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12155 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12156 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12157 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12158 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12159 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012160
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012161 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12162 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012163 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012164
12165 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12166 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12167 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12168
12169 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12170 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12171 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12172 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12173 the server takes too long to respond.
12174
12175 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12176 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12177 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12178 long a time to respond.
12179
12180 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12181 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12182 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12183 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12184 and the client.
12185
12186 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12187 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12188 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12189 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12190 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
12191 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
12192
12193 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12194 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012195 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12196 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12197 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12198 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012199
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012200 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12201 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012203 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012204 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12205 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12206 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12207 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12208 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12209
12210 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12211 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12212 503 or 504 here.
12213
12214 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12215 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12216 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12217 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12218 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12219
12220 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12221 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012222 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012223 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12224 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12225
12226 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12227 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12228 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12229 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12230 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12231 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12232 between haproxy and the server.
12233
12234 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12235 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12236 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12237 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12238 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12239 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12240 solution is to fix the application.
12241
12242 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12243 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12244 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12245 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12246 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12247 external attacks.
12248
12249 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12250 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012251 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012252 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12253 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12254
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012255 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12256 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12257 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012258 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12259 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012260
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012261 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12262 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12263 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12264 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012265 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12266 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12267 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12268 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12269 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012270
12271 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12272 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12273 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12274 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12275
12276 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12277 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12278 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12279 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12280
12281 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12282 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12283 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12284 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12285
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012286The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12287persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12288important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12289re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12290
12291 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12292
12293 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12294 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12295 set on a GET request.
12296
12297 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12298 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012299 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012300 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12301
12302 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12303 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12304 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12305
12306 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12307 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12308 already got a cookie.
12309
12310 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12311 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12312 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12313 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12314 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12315
12316 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12317 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12318 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12319
12320 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12321 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12322 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12323
12324 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12325 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12326
12327 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12328 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12329 then advertised in the response.
12330
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123328.6. Non-printable characters
12333-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012334
12335In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12336consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12337converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12338prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12339being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12340escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12341is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12342'}' when logging headers.
12343
12344Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12345issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12346containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12347
12348Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12349the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12350performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12351
12352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123538.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12354---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012355
12356Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12357achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012358section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012359cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12360the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12361the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012362locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012363not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12364user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12365a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12366wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12367
12368 Examples :
12369 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12370 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12371
12372 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12373 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12374
12375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123768.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12377---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012378
12379Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12380proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12381the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12382server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12383
12384Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12385response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012386section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012387
12388It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012389time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12390appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012391are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12392and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12393follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12394request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12395in the logs.
12396
12397 Example :
12398 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12399 listen proxy-out
12400 mode http
12401 option httplog
12402 option logasap
12403 log global
12404 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12405
12406 # log the name of the virtual server
12407 capture request header Host len 20
12408
12409 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12410 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12411
12412 # log the beginning of the referrer
12413 capture request header Referer len 20
12414
12415 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12416 capture response header Server len 20
12417
12418 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12419 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12420
12421 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12422 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12423
12424 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12425 capture response header Via len 20
12426
12427 # log the URL location during a redirection
12428 capture response header Location len 20
12429
12430 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12431 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12432 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12433 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12434 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12435
12436 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12437 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12438 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12439 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012440 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012441
12442 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12443 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12444 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12445 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12446 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012447 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012448
12449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124508.9. Examples of logs
12451---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012452
12453These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12454them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12455reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12456
12457 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12458 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12459 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12460
12461 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12462 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12463
12464 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12465 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12466 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12467
12468 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12469 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12470
12471 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12472 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12473 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12474
12475 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012476 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012477 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12478 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12479
12480 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12481 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12482 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12483
12484 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12485 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012486 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012487 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12488 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12489 to return the 502 and not the server.
12490
12491 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012492 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012493
12494 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12495 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12496 Nothing was sent to any server.
12497
12498 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12499 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12500
12501 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12502 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12503 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12504 send a 408 return code to the client.
12505
12506 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12507 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12508
12509 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12510 5 seconds ("c----").
12511
12512 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12513 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012514 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012515
12516 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012517 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012518 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12519 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12520 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12521 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12522 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012523
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012524
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125259. Statistics and monitoring
12526----------------------------
12527
12528It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12529mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12530CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12531Unix socket.
12532
12533
125349.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012535---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012536
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012537The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12538page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12539
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012540 0. pxname: proxy name
12541 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12542 for server)
12543 2. qcur: current queued requests
12544 3. qmax: max queued requests
12545 4. scur: current sessions
12546 5. smax: max sessions
12547 6. slim: sessions limit
12548 7. stot: total sessions
12549 8. bin: bytes in
12550 9. bout: bytes out
12551 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012552 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012553 12. ereq: request errors
12554 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012555 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012556 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12557 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012558 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012559 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12560 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12561 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12562 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12563 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12564 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12565 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12566 25. qlimit: queue limit
12567 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12568 27. iid: unique proxy id
12569 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12570 29. throttle: warm up status
12571 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12572 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012573 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012574 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12575 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12576 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012577 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012578 UNK -> unknown
12579 INI -> initializing
12580 SOCKERR -> socket error
12581 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12582 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12583 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12584 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12585 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12586 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12587 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12588 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12589 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12590 disable-on-404
12591 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12592 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12593 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012594 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12595 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012596 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12597 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12598 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12599 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12600 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12601 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012602 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12603 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12604 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12605 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012606 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12607 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012608 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12609 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12610 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012611 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010012612 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012613
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012614
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126159.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012616-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012617
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012618The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12619necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12620A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12621issuing commands by hand :
12622
12623 global
12624 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12625 stats timeout 2m
12626
12627It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12628the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12629never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12630situations :
12631
12632 global
12633 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12634 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12635 stats timeout 2m
12636
12637To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12638swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12639to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12640syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12641
12642 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12643 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12644
12645The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12646script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12647for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12648
12649The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12650that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12651editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12652(eg: watch a counter).
12653
12654The socket supports two operation modes :
12655 - interactive
12656 - non-interactive
12657
12658The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12659this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12660sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12661mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12662commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12663example :
12664
12665 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12666
12667The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12668entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12669for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12670sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12671"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12672after processing the last command of the same line.
12673
12674For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12675"prompt" command :
12676
12677 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12678 prompt
12679 > show info
12680 ...
12681 >
12682
12683Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12684delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12685that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12686parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012687
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012688It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12689on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12690own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012691
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012692The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12693If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12694all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12695it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12696
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012697add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012698 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
12699 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
12700 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
12701 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012702
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012703add map <map> <key> <value>
12704 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12705 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012706 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
12707 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
12708 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012709
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012710clear counters
12711 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12712 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12713 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12714 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12715 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12716
12717clear counters all
12718 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12719 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12720 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12721
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012722clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012723 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
12724 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
12725 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012726
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012727clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012728 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
12729 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
12730 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012731
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012732clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12733 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12734
12735 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12736 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12737 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12738 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12739 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12740 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12741
12742 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12743
12744 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12745 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12746 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12747 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12748 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12749 the ACLs :
12750
12751 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12752 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12753 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12754 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12755 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12756 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12757
12758 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012759 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12760 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012761
12762 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012763 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012764 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012765 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12766 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12767 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12768 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012769
12770 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12771
12772 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012773 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012774 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12775 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012776 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12777 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12778 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012779
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012780del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
12781 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012782 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
12783 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
12784 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
12785 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012786
12787del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010012788 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012789 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
12790 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
12791 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
12792 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010012793
12794disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012795 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
12796
12797 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
12798 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
12799 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
12800 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
12801 re-enabled using enable agent.
12802
12803 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
12804 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
12805 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
12806 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
12807 otherwise unchanged.
12808
12809 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
12810 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
12811 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
12812
12813 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12814 level "admin".
12815
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012816disable frontend <frontend>
12817 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12818 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12819 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12820 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12821 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12822 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12823 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12824 on the stats page.
12825
12826 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12827 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12828
12829 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12830 level "admin".
12831
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012832disable server <backend>/<server>
12833 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12834 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12835 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12836 during the maintenance.
12837
12838 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12839 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12840
12841 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012842 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012843
12844 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12845 level "admin".
12846
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012847enable agent <backend>/<server>
12848 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
12849
12850 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
12851 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
12852
12853 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12854 level "admin".
12855
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012856enable frontend <frontend>
12857 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12858 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12859 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12860 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12861 which was disabled.
12862
12863 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12864 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12865
12866 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12867 level "admin".
12868
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012869enable server <backend>/<server>
12870 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12871 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12872
12873 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012874 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012875
12876 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12877 level "admin".
12878
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010012879get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012880get acl <acl> <value>
12881 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
12882 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
12883 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
12884 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
12885 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010012886
12887 The first two words are:
12888
12889 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
12890 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
12891 "dom", "end" or "reg".
12892
12893 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
12894
12895 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
12896
12897 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
12898
12899 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
12900 interpretation of the case.
12901
12902 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
12903 useful with regular expressions.
12904
12905 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
12906 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
12907
12908 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
12909 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
12910 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
12911
12912 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
12913
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012914get weight <backend>/<server>
12915 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12916 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12917 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12918 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12919 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012920 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012921
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012922help
12923 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12924 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012925
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012926prompt
12927 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12928 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12929 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12930 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12931 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12932 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12933 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12934 command.
12935
12936quit
12937 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012938
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012939set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012940 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
12941 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
12942 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012943
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012944set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012945 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12946 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12947 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12948 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12949 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012950 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12951 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12952
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012953set maxconn global <maxconn>
12954 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12955 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12956 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12957 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12958 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12959 setting.
12960
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012961set rate-limit connections global <value>
12962 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12963 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12964 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12965 is passed in number of connections per second.
12966
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012967set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
12968 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
12969 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010012970 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
12971 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012972
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020012973set rate-limit sessions global <value>
12974 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
12975 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12976 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12977 is passed in number of sessions per second.
12978
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020012979set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
12980 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
12981 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12982 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12983 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
12984 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
12985
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012986set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012987 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
12988 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
12989 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
12990 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012991 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
12992 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012993
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012994set timeout cli <delay>
12995 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
12996 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
12997 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
12998
12999set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13000 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13001 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013002 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13003 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13004 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13005 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13006 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13007 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13008 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13009 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13010 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13011 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13012 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13013 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13014 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013015
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013016show errors [<iid>]
13017 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13018 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013019 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13020 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13021 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013022
13023 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13024 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13025 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13026 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13027 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13028 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13029 are reported too.
13030
13031 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13032 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13033 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13034 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13035 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13036 code.
13037
13038 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13039 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13040 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13041 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13042 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13043 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13044 line.
13045
13046 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013047 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13048 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013049 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13050 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13051
13052 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13053 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13054 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13055 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13056 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13057 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13058 00204+ minal\r\n
13059 00211 \r\n
13060
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013061 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013062 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13063 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13064 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13065 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13066 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13067 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013068
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013069show info
13070 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13071
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013072show map [<map>]
13073 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013074 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13075 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13076 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13077 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13078 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13079 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013080
13081show acl [<acl>]
13082 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013083 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13084 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13085 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13086 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13087 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013088
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013089show pools
13090 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13091 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13092 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13093 the pools.
13094
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013095show sess
13096 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013097 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13098 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13099
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013100show sess <id>
13101 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13102 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13103 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13104 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13105 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013106 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13107 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13108 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013109
13110show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13111 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13112 possible to dump only selected items :
13113 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13114 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13115 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13116 for example:
13117 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13118 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13119 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13120
13121 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013122 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13123 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013124 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13125 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13126 Nbproc: 1
13127 Process_num: 1
13128 (...)
13129
13130 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13131 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13132 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13133 (...)
13134 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13135
13136 $
13137
13138 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13139 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13140 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13141 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013142 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013143
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013144show table
13145 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13146 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13147 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13148 entries currently in use.
13149
13150 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013151 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013152 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13153 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013154
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013155show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013156 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13157 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13158 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013159 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13160
13161 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13162 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13163 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13164 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13165 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13166
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013167 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13168 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13169 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13170 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13171 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13172 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13173
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013174
13175 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013176 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13177 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013178
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013179 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013180 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013181 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013182 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13183 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13184 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13185 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013186
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013187 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013188 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013189 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13190 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013191
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013192 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13193 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013194 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013195 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13196 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013197
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013198 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13199 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013200 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013201 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13202 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13203
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013204 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13205 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13206 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13207 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13208 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13209
13210 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13211 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13212 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013213 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13214 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013215 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13216 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013217
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013218shutdown frontend <frontend>
13219 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13220 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13221 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13222 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13223 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13224 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13225 once it is terminated.
13226
13227 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13228 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13229
13230 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13231 level "admin".
13232
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013233shutdown session <id>
13234 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13235 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13236 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13237 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13238 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13239 flag in the logs.
13240
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013241shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13242 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13243 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13244 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13245 'K' flag in the logs.
13246
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013247/*
13248 * Local variables:
13249 * fill-column: 79
13250 * End:
13251 */